M410
M412
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Edition: May 2000
The following paragraph does not apply to any country where such provisions are inconsistent with local law: LEXMARK INTERNATIONAL, INC.,
PROVIDES THIS PUBLICATION “AS IS” WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING, BUT NOT
LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY OR FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. Some states do not allow
disclaimer of express or implied warranties in certain transactions; therefore, this statement may not apply to you.
This publication could include technical inaccuracies or typographical errors. Changes are periodically made to the information herein; these changes
will be incorporated in later editions. Improvements or changes in the products or the programs described may be made at any time.
A form for the reader’s comments is provided at the back of this publication. If the form has been removed, comments may be addressed to Lexmark
International, Inc., Department F95/ 035-3, 740 West New Circle Road, Lexington, Kentucky 40550, U.S.A. In the United Kingdom and Eire, send to
Lexmark International Ltd., Marketing and Services Department, Westhorpe House, Westhorpe, Marlow Bucks SL7 3RQ. Lexmark may use or distribute
any of the information you supply in any way it believes appropriate without incurring any obligation to you. You can purchase additional copies of
publications related to this product by calling 1-800-553-9727. In the United Kingdom and Eire, call 0628-481500. In other countries, contact your point of
purchase.
References in this publication to products, programs, or services do not imply that the manufacturer intends to make these available in all countries in
which it operates. Any reference to a product, program, or service is not intended to state or imply that only that product, program, or service may be
used. Any functionally equivalent product, program, or service that does not infringe any existing intellectual property right may be used instead.
Evaluation and verification of operation in conjunction with other products, programs, or services, except those expressly designated by the
manufacturer, are the user’s responsibility.
© Copyright 1999, 2000 Lexmark International, Inc.
All rights reserved.
UNITED STATES GOVERNMENT RESTRICTED RIGHTS
This software and documentation are provided with RESTRICTED RIGHTS. Use, duplication or disclosure by the Government is subject to restrictions
as set forth in subparagraph (c)(1)(ii) of the Rights in Technical Data and Computer Software clause at DFARS 252.227-7013 and in applicable FAR
provisions: Lexmark International, Inc., Lexington, KY 40550.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Table of
Contents
About This Book . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ix
Other Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . x
Unpacking Your Printer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1
Installing the Paper Bail . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11
Plugging the Printer In . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20
Turning the Printer Power On . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20
Printing the Menu Settings Page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21
Table of Contents
iii
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MarkVision for Intranet Servers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26
Lexmark MarkTrack . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28
Lexmark NetPnP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29
Optra Forms . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30
Printer Indicator Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34
Printer Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37
Status Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37
Attendance Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37
Service Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37
Operator Panel Menus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38
Paper Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44
Finishing Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53
Utilities Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 57
Job Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 59
Quality Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71
Setup Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 73
PCL Emul Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 79
Parallel Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 84
Table of Contents
iv
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Infrared Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 93
LocalTalk Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 96
USB Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99
Fax Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102
Config Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106
Confidential Jobs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108
Held Jobs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109
Paper Sources and Sizes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116
Paper . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 118
Letterhead . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 118
Transparencies . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119
Envelopes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119
Labels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120
Card Stock Guidelines . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122
Storing Print Material . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123
Loading Print Material . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124
Printing on Letterhead . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135
Avoiding Paper Jams . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 137
Table of Contents
v
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Loading Print Material . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 143
Status Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 151
Line 1 Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 152
Warning Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 158
Attendance Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 159
Display Problems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 175
Printing Problems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 176
Option Problems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 180
Possible Paper Jam Areas . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 184
Replacing the Print Cartridge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 194
Cleaning the Printhead Lens . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 195
Ordering a Charge Roll Kit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 195
Table of Contents
vi
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Choosing Hardware . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 197
Setting Up a Fax Port . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 198
Disabling a Fax Port . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 200
Printer Memory . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 206
Flash Memory . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 206
Installing Memory Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 207
Hard Disk Option . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 212
Installing an Option Card . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 216
Installing the Optional Drawer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 223
Table of Contents
vii
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Typefaces and Fonts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 231
Weight and Style . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 231
Resident Fonts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 235
Symbol Sets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 239
Downloadable Fonts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 241
Printing a Font Sample List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 242
Table of Contents
viii
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Introduction
About This Book This User’s Guide contains information about the Lexmark
Optra M410 and M412 laser printers. It provides setup
instructions for the printer and printer options as well as
information about loading print material, changing
printer settings, replacing printer supplies, and trouble-
shooting problems.
Keep this book in a handy place and use it as a reference
when you have a question about printer function or if you
encounter a printing problem.
It may be helpful for you to recognize the following con-
ventions used throughout this book:
•
•
Notes, warnings, and cautions appear in the left col-
umn for easy reference.
Note: A note provides informa-
tion you may find useful.
Operator panel buttons are printed in boldface type:
Warning! A warning identifies
something that could damage
your printer hardware or soft-
ware.
Press Go after changing a menu setting.
•
Messages, menu names, menu items, and menu set-
tings that appear on the operator panel display are
also printed in boldface type:
Caution! A caution identifies
something that could cause you
harm.
If Load Tray 1 appears on the operator panel dis-
play, you must load print material in tray 1 and
press Go before you can resume printing.
Introduction
ix
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
The Paper Source setting is available in the PAPER
MENU.
Other Information In addition to this User’s Guide, Lexmark offers the follow-
ing sources of information about your printer and other
Lexmark products and services.
Online Documents
The Drivers, MarkVision and Utilities compact disc (CD)
that comes with your printer contains several online docu-
ments. Refer to the booklet that comes with the CD for
launching instructions. Once you launch the CD, click
View Documentation to display a list of available docu-
ments.
The CD includes:
The MarkVision printer utility information, which pro-
vides step-by-step instructions for installing MarkVision
for Windows 95/ 98/ 2000, Windows NT 4.0, Macintosh,
and OS/ 2 on several different networks. It also describes
some of the most popular MarkVision features.
•
Documents which provide general information
about setting up an optional print server after
installing it in your printer.
•
•
Documents which describe font options and avail-
able resources.
A Card Stock & Label Guide which provides detailed
information about selecting print material appropri-
ate for your printer.
•
A Technical Reference which includes information
about printer languages and commands, interface
specification, and printer memory management.
Introduction
x
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Trademarks
Lexmark, Lexmark with diamond design, MarkNet,
MarkVision, and Optra are trademarks of Lexmark Inter-
national, Inc., registered in the United States and/ or other
countries.
MarkTrack, Optra Forms, and PictureGrade are trade-
marks of Lexmark International, Inc.
Operation ReSource is a service mark of Lexmark Interna-
tional, Inc.
PCL® is a registered trademark of the Hewlett-Packard
Company. PCL 6 is Hewlett-Packard Company’s designa-
tions of a set of printer commands (language) and func-
tions included in its printer products. This printer is
intended to be compatible with the PCL 6 language. This
means the printer recognizes PCL 6 commands used in
various application programs, and that the printer emu-
lates the functions corresponding to the commands.
PostScript® is a registered trademark of Adobe Systems
Incorporated. PostScript 3 is Adobe Systems’ designation
of a set of printer commands (language), fonts, and func-
tions included in its software products. This printer is
intended to be compatible with the PostScript 3 language.
This means the printer recognizes PostScript 3 commands
used in various application programs, and that the printer
emulates the functions corresponding to the commands.
Details relating to compatibility are included in the
Technical Reference.
Trademarks
xi
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
The following terms are trademarks or registered trade-
marks of these companies.
Albertus
The Monotype Corporation plc.
Monsieur Marcel OLIVE
Antique Olive
Arial
The Monotype Corporation plc.
A product of Bayer Corporation
CG Omega
CG Times
Based on Times New Roman under
license from The Monotype
Corporation plc, is a product of
Bayer Corporation
Helvetica
Linotype-Hell AG and/ or its
subsidiaries
Intellifont
Bayer Corporation
ITC Bookman
International Typeface Corporation
ITC Zapf Chancery International Typeface Corporation
LocalTalk
Macintosh
Marigold
Palatino
Apple Computer, Inc.
Apple Computer, Inc.
AlphaOmega Typography, Inc.
Linotype-Hell AG and/ or its
subsidiaries
Pantone
Pantone, Inc.
PostScript
Adobe Systems Incorporated
Times New Roman The Monotype Corporation plc.
TrueType
Univers
Apple Computer, Inc.
Linotype-Hell AG and/ or its
subsidiaries
Wingdings
Microsoft Corporation
Other trademarks are the property of their respective
owners.
Trademarks
xii
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Setting Up
Your Printer
1
Complete the following sections to set up your Lexmark™
Optra™ M410 and M412 printers.
Unpacking
Your Printer
1 Remove the printer and all items from the packag-
ing carton.
Save the carton and packing materials in case you
need to repack the printer for service or storage.
Plastic Bracket
2 Make sure you have the items shown.
Printer
If any items are missing, contact the place where
you bought your printer.
3 Place the printer on a flat, sturdy surface in a well-
ventilated area.
Allow at least 304.8 mm (12 in.) of clearance on all
sides of the printer. Since you may want to install
the optional 500-sheet drawer, leave at least
129.6 mm (5.1 in.) clearance above the printer. Leave
enough space in front of the printer to allow for
easy paper access.
Power
Cord
Metal
Bail
User’s
Guide
CD
Unpacking Your Printer
1
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Use the following information to help determine
where to place your printer.
Characteristic
Measurement
435 mm (17.1 in.)
314 mm (12.4 in.)
405 mm (15.9 in.)
14.8 kg (32.6 lb)
246 sq. in.
Depth
Height
Width
Weight
1
Footprint
1
Weight of printer includes print cartridge.
Do not place the printer:
– In direct sunlight.
– Near heat sources or air conditioners.
– In dusty or dirty environments.
Removing Print To remove the print cartridge packaging:
Cartridge
Packaging
1 Push the upper release latch to release the upper
Upper
Front Door
front door.
Chapter 1: Setting Up Your Printer
2
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2 Raise the upper front door.
It remains in place.
3 Grasp the print cartridge by the handgrip.
Removing Print Cartridge Packaging
3
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
4 Lift the print cartridge up and pull out.
5 Pull up on each end of the plastic piece and then
remove the packaging material.
Discard all packaging material: the plastic piece, the
foam, and the paper connected to the foam.
Chapter 1: Setting Up Your Printer
4
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Installing the To prepare the print cartridge for printing:
Print Cartridge
1 Gently shake the print cartridge side-to-side to
distribute the toner.
2 Insert the print cartridge:
Tab
Slot
a Align the tabs located on each side of the print
cartridge with the slots on either side of the
print cartridge cradle as shown.
Use the colored arrows inside the printer for
placement.
Installing the Print Cartridge
5
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
b Slide the print cartridge straight back into the
printer until it snaps into place.
3 Close the upper front door.
You cannot close the door completely if the print
cartridge is not installed correctly.
Loading the Your printer has one standard 250-sheet input tray that
holds five paper sizes. For information on the different
sizes and types of print material you can use with your
Standard
Input Tray
For information on loading envelopes and other types of
To load paper:
1 Pull the input tray straight out of the printer.
Remove the input tray completely from the printer.
Chapter 1: Setting Up Your Printer
6
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2 Press down on the metal plate until it locks into
place.
The metal plate remains stationary on the inside
bottom of the input tray.
3 Press down on the length guide tab with one
hand, and with the other hand slide the length
guide to the correct position for the size paper you
are loading.
Paper Size
Indicators
Length Guide
Length
Guide
Tab
Use the paper size indicators to adjust the length
guide for one of the following five paper sizes: A4,
B5, LTR (Letter), LGL (Legal), and EXEC (Execu-
tive).
Paper Size
Indicators
Note: The paper size indica-
tors are paper size abbreviations
used for the placement of the
length guide as shown. This
example shows how to adjust for
letter-size paper (LTR).
Loading the Standard Input Tray
7
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
4 Press down on the width guide tab and slide the
width guide to the far right side of the input tray
as shown.
Width Guide Tab
Width Guide
5 Flex the sheets back and forth to loosen them, then
fan them. Do not fold or crease the paper.
Straighten the edges on a level surface.
For this setup, load letter-size paper.
Chapter 1: Setting Up Your Printer
8
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 Place the paper against the left side of the input
tray and insert it under the metal stop.
Make sure the recommended print side is face down
and the front edge is placed toward the front of the
input tray.
For information on how to load letterhead, see
Metal Stop
Note: Make sure the paper fits
easily under the metal stop and
is not bent or wrinkled. Do not
raise the metal stop or force
paper under the metal stop.
Overfilling the input tray may
cause paper jams.
7 Do not exceed the maximum stack height indi-
cated by the line under the arrows.
Stack Height
Indicator
Note: Overfilling the input tray
may cause paper jams.
Loading the Standard Input Tray
9
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
8 Push on the right side of the width guide to move
it to the left until it lightly touches the edge of the
paper.
Width Guide
Note: Sliding the width guide
too tight against the paper may
cause misfeeds.
9 Slide the input tray all the way into the printer
until it snaps into place.
Chapter 1: Setting Up Your Printer
10
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Installing the The paper bail helps prevent offset bin stacking by guid-
ing print material into the standard output bin.
Paper Bail
The paper bail consists of two parts: a plastic bracket
already installed on the printer and a metal bail.
Complete the following steps to install the metal bail:
1 Locate the metal bail that comes with your printer.
2 Orient the metal bail as shown.
3 Place the tips of the metal bail into the holes
Plastic Bracket
located on either end of the plastic bracket as
Metal Bail
shown.
Note: The paper bail is not
depicted in other illustrations
throughout this book now that
you have installed it.
Installing the Paper Bail
11
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Connecting Your To print from your computer, you need to connect your
printer to your computer with either a parallel interface
cable or a Universal Serial Bus (USB) cable.
Printer to a
Computer
Using a
Parallel Cable
Your printer uses an IEEE 1284-compliant parallel cable
that supports bidirectional communication. We recom-
mend Lexmark part number 1329605 (10 ft) or
1427498 (20 ft). If you use a cable other than an IEEE-com-
pliant cable, you may not be able to access all of your
printer functions.
1 Turn the printer power Off (O) and unplug the
printer power cord from the electrical outlet.
Caution! To avoid electrical
shock hazards, make sure your
computer power is Off (O) and
unplug all computer equipment
before connecting cables.
2 Align and plug the parallel cable into the parallel
connector as shown.
Parallel
Cable
Parallel Connector
Chapter 1: Setting Up Your Printer
12
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
3 Push the clips at each end of the connector down
into the notches on the plug as shown. The clips
snap into the notches.
4 Connect the other end of the parallel cable to the
back of your computer. Tighten the screws on the
parallel cable to the computer.
5 Check the parallel cable connections to make sure
they are completely secured.
Clips
Connecting Your Printer to a Computer
13
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Using a USB Cable
Your printer has one standard USB port located on the
printer system board.
Complete the following steps to connect your printer
using a USB cable.
For Windows 2000 users:
1 Make sure the computer and printer power are Off
(O) and the printer power cord is unplugged from
the electrical outlet.
2 Connect the USB cable to the port on the back of
your computer.
3 Connect the other end of the cable to the USB port
on the back of your printer.
4 Turn on your computer and your printer.
5 When the Found New Hardware Wizard screen
appears, select Cancel to close the wizard.
USB
Cable
6 Insert the CD that came with your printer and
select Start.
7 From the Start menu, select Run, then click Browse.
8 Click on the My Computer shortcut in the Browse
window, double-click on the CD icon, and double-
click on the Setup icon.
USB Port
9
Click OK to start the printer driver installation
program.
10 Follow the installation instructions in the printer
drivers dialog box.
11 In the Print to the following port check box, select
the USB port that best describes the order you’ve
connected USB printers to your computer (for
example, the first USB printer is USB001, the sec-
ond USB002, and so on).
Chapter 1: Setting Up Your Printer
14
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
12 In the Select a port for this printer check box, select
the USB port that best describes the order
you’ve connected USB printers to your com-
puter (for example, the first USB printer is
USB001, the second USB002, and so on).
13 When you finish, exit the setup program and
remove the CD from your computer.
For Windows 98 users:
1 Make sure the printer power is Off (O) and the
printer power cord is unplugged from the electri-
cal outlet.
2 Align and plug the USB cable into the USB port on
the back of your printer as shown.
3 Connect the other end of the USB cable to the back
of your computer.
USB
Cable
4 Check the cable connections to make sure they are
completely secured.
USB Port
7 Complete the following steps to setup the printer
port and install the correct drivers.
When you turn the printer power On (| ), the Add
New Hardware Wizard screen appears on your com-
puter.
a Click Next.
b Click the default to search for the best driver.
Click Next.
c Click to clear the check boxes for Floppy Disk or
CD-ROM.
Connecting Your Printer to a Computer
15
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
d Insert the compact disc (CD) that came with
your printer.
e Click Specify a location.
f
Click Browse.
g Scroll down until you locate your CD-ROM
drive. Double-click to select it.
h Highlight the folder for WIN98USB and click
OK.
i
Click Next.
A screen displays indicating the application is
looking for this laser printer to verify the driver
for the printer.
j
Click Next.
Wait as the information processes. When the next
screen appears that tells you the software is
installed, click Finish. Complete the following to
install the printer driver.
k Click Install Software.
l
Click Printer Software.
The Choose your Installation Path screen
displays.
m Select Install from this CD.
The License Agreement displays.
n Click Agree once you have read the agreement.
o Select Custom Install and click Next.
Printer Drivers is selected as the default on the
next screen.
p Click Next.
q Scroll through the list of printers on the left of
the screen and click the check box to select
Optra M410 or Optra M412.
Chapter 1: Setting Up Your Printer
16
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
r Click the Add button.
The name of your printer moves to the box on
the right of the screen.
s Click Next.
The Drivers tab screen displays.
t
Highlight LPT1 in the top window of the screen
for the PostScript language.
u Scroll to USB001 in the bottom window of the
screen and select it.
v Return to the top window of the screen and
select LPT1 for the PCL language.
w Scroll to USB001 in the bottom window of the
screen and select it.
x Click Finish Installation.
Wait as the information processes.
y Click Yes to restart Windows.
z Click OK.
Connecting Your Printer to a Computer
17
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
For Macintosh users:
1 Make sure the printer power is Off (O) and the
printer power cord is unplugged from the electri-
cal outlet.
2 Connect the end of the USB cable to the port on
your computer.
3 Align and plug the other end of the USB cable into
the port on the back of your printer as shown.
USB
Cable
6 Launch the CD to install the necessary items.
Instructions to launch the CD are in the CD
booklet.
USB Port
7 Restart the computer.
8 Open the Apples Extras folder.
9 Open the Apple LaserWriter Software folder.
10 Open the Desktop Printer Utility application.
11 The New Desktop Printer screen displays.
12 Select Printer (USB) from the list and click OK.
13 In the USB printer selection area, click Change.
The USB printer dialog box displays.
14 Select Optra M410 or Optra M412 and click OK.
The previous screen displays. Notice the new
printer icon.
15 In the PostScript printer description (PPD) file,
click Auto Setup.
Wait for the information to process.
Chapter 1: Setting Up Your Printer
18
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
The previous screen displays. Notice the new
printer icon.
Note: Both areas of the printer
dialog box show the Optra M410
or Optra M412 printer icons.
16 Click Create.
A window appears for you to name the printer.
17 Type in the name of the printer or accept the
default name.
18 Click Save.
19 Quit the Desktop Printer Utility application.
The printer icon displays on your Desktop.
20 Click the new desktop printer icon.
The Printing menu appears on the menu bar.
21 Scroll down in the Printing menu and select Set
Default Printer.
A dark line appears around the printer in the
printer icon to indicate it is selected as the default
printer.
Connecting Your Printer to a Computer
19
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Plugging the
Printer In
1 Plug the printer power cord into the connector as
shown.
2 Plug the other end of the printer power cord into a
properly grounded electrical outlet.
Printer
Power Cord
Turning the Printer Turn the printer power On (| ).
Power On
Chapter 1: Setting Up Your Printer
20
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Printing the Menu The menu settings page shows current settings for the
menus, a list of installed options, and available printer
Settings Page
memory. You can use this page to verify that all printer
options are properly installed and the printer settings are
set to what you want.
page 2 before printing a page.
1 Make sure the printer power is On (| ) and the
Ready status message appears on the display.
2 Press Menu> or <Menu to enter the menus.
3 Continue to press and release Menu> or <Menu until
you see UTILITIES MENU on the second line of the
display.
4 Press Select.
identify the display and operator
panel buttons if you need help.
5 Press Menu> until Print Menus appears on the sec-
ond line of the display.
6 Press Select.
The message Printing Menu Settings appears and
remains on the operator panel display until the
page prints. The printer returns to the Ready state
after the menu settings page prints.
Printing the Menu Settings Page
21
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Installing the If English is your preferred language, continue with
Operator Panel
If English is not your preferred language, complete the fol-
lowing steps to customize the operator panel.
Overlay
1 Locate the operator panel overlay.
If this User’s Guide is printed in a language other
than English, an overlay for the operator panel is
included with the printer. The overlay has trans-
lated names for the operator panel buttons.
2 Peel the protective backing off the overlay.
3 Align the operator panel overlay on the operator
panel and press it into place as shown.
Rub the overlay firmly to make sure that it adheres
securely.
4 Peel the protective covering away from the top of
the overlay.
language to match the overlay.
Chapter 1: Setting Up Your Printer
22
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Changing the Complete the following steps to change the language of
the menus and messages that appear on the operator
panel display:
Operator Panel
Display Language
1 Press the Menu> or <Menu button to enter the
menus.
2 Continue to press and release Menu> or <Menu until
SETUP MENU appears on the second line of the dis-
play.
Note: The Select button acts
upon information that appears
3 Press the Select button.
on the second line of the opera-
tor panel display.
4 Press Menu> until Display Language appears on the
second line of the display.
5 Press Select.
6 Press Menu> until your preferred language appears
identify the display and operator
panel buttons if you need help.
on the second line of the display.
7 Press Select.
The printer resets and displays text in the requested
language.
Changing the Operator Panel Display Language
23
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Installing Printer
Drivers and
Utilities
1 Locate the Drivers, MarkVision and Utilities CD
that comes with your printer.
If your computer does not have a CD-ROM drive,
you can transfer the information on the CD to dis-
kettes. Locate a computer with a CD-ROM drive,
start the CD-ROM utility, and follow the instruc-
tions presented to create diskettes.
Note: Consult your network
software documentation for
more information. Also, see
page 25 for more information.
2 Follow the instructions in the booklet included
with the CD to start the printer setup utility.
The setup utility lets you install printer drivers and
utilities to manage Lexmark printers attached to
page 25 for more information.
3 If necessary, use standard network software to
identify the printer to the LAN and to complete
any other setup that may be needed.
Chapter 1: Setting Up Your Printer
24
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MarkVision
2
MarkVision Printer This section provides a brief overview of the MarkVision
printer utility and some of its key features. For more infor-
Management
mation on MarkVision, refer to the online Help or the doc-
umentation on the Drivers, MarkVision and Utilities CD that
comes with your printer:
Software
•
•
Introduction to MarkVision
Installation Tips
Operating Systems
Supported
MarkVision for Windows 95/ 98/ 2000, Windows NT 4.0,
Macintosh, and OS/ 2 Warp is shipped with your printer
on the Drivers, MarkVision and Utilities CD.
Introducing
MarkVision
The MarkVision graphical user interface provides
advanced, real-time, centralized management capabilities
for Lexmark printers connected locally or attached
directly to a network. Network users and administrators
can also use the following MarkVision features to increase
productivity:
•
Centralized setup capabilities let you quickly con-
figure and install multiple printers.
– You can configure multiple printers simulta-
neously from one workstation.
– Automatic network printer discovery and multi-
adapter flash update let you set up and configure
MarkVision Printer Management Software
25
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Lexmark network printers and change network
addresses from one workstation.
•
Use MarkVision to easily manage and monitor your
Lexmark printers.
Note: You can integrate
MarkVision directly into your
favorite network management
software.
– Messages on the MarkVision remote operator
panel reflect printer real-time status.
– The dynamic printer graphic provides a visual
confirmation of installed options.
– A list of installed features shows you printer
capabilities.
•
MarkVision provides the tools to make printer-
related administrative tasks effortless.
Note: Management capabili-
ties for multivendor printers are
available in some versions of
MarkVision.
– Monitor network print jobs, change their print-
ing order, and hold or delete specific jobs.
– Use asset management options to maintain
printer inventory, assign property tags, track
page counts, and gather job statistics.
– Download and manage resources such as fonts,
demo pages, and overlays.
MarkVision for This section provides a brief overview of MarkVision for
Intranet Servers and some of its key features. For more
information on MarkVision for Intranet Servers, refer to
the documentation installed with the software:
Intranet Servers
•
•
MarkVision for Intranets User’s Guide.
MarkVision Installation and Configuration Guide.
This document is also located on the Drivers,
MarkVision and Utilities CD that comes with your
printer.
Introducing
MarkVision for
Intranet Servers
MarkVision for Intranet Servers is a Web-based printer
management utility that:
•
Lets you monitor and manage devices using a Web
browser from any PC with intranet access.
Chapter 2: MarkVision
26
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
•
•
•
Enables print management over your existing intra-
net infrastructure using TCP/ IP.
Offers a cross-platform solution for Windows and
UNIX users.
Lets you manage multivendor printers.
Network users and administrators can also use the follow-
ing MarkVision features to increase productivity.
Maps
Locate printers quickly in your organization by position-
ing printer icons on a map to show not only printer status,
but also actual printer location.
Filters
Search for devices using criteria such as printer status and
installed features.
Filters automatically organize printers into groups based
on real-time status information.
Remote Updates
Remotely update firmware on multiple Lexmark print
servers simultaneously.
MarkVision for MarkVision for UNIX/ Sun offers enterprise scalability,
reliability, and performance that helps you easily set up,
UNIX Networks
manage, and maintain printers across networks. Ulti-
mately, this reduces help desk costs and increases network
administrator productivity using:
•
•
•
•
Centralized Lexmark printer setup capabilities.
Remote monitoring and management.
Proactive status alerts on Lexmark printers.
Tools that allocate printing expenses, balance work-
load, and access printing resources.
MarkVision for UNIX Networks
27
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MarkVision Simple Network Management Protocol
(SNMP) Services let administrators manage popular mul-
tivendor printers.
MarkVision for UNIX Networks and Intranet Servers is
recommended to assist in remote printer setup for UNIX
platforms.
To purchase MarkVision for UNIX, contact the place
where you bought your printer or visit the Lexmark Web
site at www.lexmark.com.
Lexmark MarkTrack™ is a network printer reporting software
package that helps administrators manage printing envi-
ronments more efficiently. Administrators can use Mark-
Track to:
MarkTrack
•
Retrieve and analyze network printer information
from a Web browser.
•
•
•
•
Allocate printing resources more efficiently.
Make better purchasing decisions.
Allocate printing costs to different departments.
Provide statistical information on employee print-
ing habits.
•
•
Track Lexmark and SNMP-compliant printers.
Collect, analyze, and create reports using MarkVi-
sion Printer Inventory and Job Statistics data or
SNMP MIB data.
•
•
•
Create reports using a Web server.
View reports using a Web browser.
Create an inventory of network printer assets auto-
matically.
•
•
Analyze printing for the enterprise.
Plan ahead for supplies purchases, maintenance
schedules, and printer replacement.
For more information on MarkTrack, refer to the product
information, contact the place where you bought your
Chapter 2: MarkVision
28
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
printer, or visit the Lexmark Web site at
www.lexmark.com.
Lexmark NetPnP NetPnP automates the configuration and installation of
Lexmark printers on a network. NetPnP senses when a
new printer is attached to the network, automatically cre-
ates a shared printer object on a Windows NT 4.0 system,
and notifies users by e-mail that the printer is available for
printing. It also notifies IT administrators by e-mail when
a new printer is detected or when an error occurs during
automatic printer installation.
•
Lets administrators make printers available to users
within seconds.
•
Extends network printer installation to include the
end user by installing all necessary components that
enable printing to workstations across the network.
•
•
Provides huge productivity gains when rolling out
large numbers of network printers.
Supports a wide range of printer installation
options for IT administrators, from fully automatic
installation to prompted confirmations.
•
•
Lets you customize network printer installation in
Windows NT environments running TCP/ IP.
Automates the setup of Lexmark network printers,
eliminating more than a dozen steps in the process.
Software On the Drivers, MarkVision and Utilities CD, Lexmark's all-
in-one software installation utility provides IT administra-
tors with time-saving installation and distribution tools
that enhance productivity and improve efficiency.
Installation and
Distribution Tools
•
Software installation and updates by way of the
Lexmark Web site.
Users can initiate Web updates or schedule updates
to run periodically. This ensures that users have the
most recent version of Lexmark software and driv-
Lexmark NetPnP
29
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
ers on their workstations with the least amount of
effort.
•
•
Scripting capability to distribute software to users
on the network.
IT administrators can store software and driver
installation settings in a file. This file can then be
used to automatically distribute the software to
multiple workstations simultaneously.
Distribution of drivers with custom settings to
users.
IT administrators can remotely install, update, and
distribute drivers with custom settings to users on
the network, eliminating time-consuming worksta-
tion driver installation and configuration.
Optra Forms Optra Forms combines data from a customer’s application
with printer-resident electronic forms to produce com-
pleted forms such as invoices, statements, pick slips,
labels, and purchase orders. Support for bar codes, spe-
cialized graphics and other options is included.
The same data can be sent to several remote printers with
different resident forms so that the completed forms can
be customized for the specific printer location. For exam-
ple, the same purchase order information can be sent to
different printers and printed with different addresses and
logos.
Optra Forms:
•
Requires no server-based or host-based merge pro-
gram or software.
•
Can be used:
– With virtually any ASCII text print file from any
platform, mainframe, AS/ 400, UNIX or worksta-
tion.
– Over Coax, Twinax, parallel, serial or LAN
(TCP/ IP).
•
Generally makes no changes to database applica-
tions.
Chapter 2: MarkVision
30
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
•
•
•
Prints different forms at different locations from the
same database.
Globally updates forms quickly and easily over the
LAN.
Provides support for bar codes, color, duplex, multi-
page form sets, and more.
•
•
Stores forms as efficient, compact forms in flash.
Works with Optra M410 and M412 printers and the
Optra T and Optra W laser printer families using
the Optra Forms™ 1, 2, 4, 8, and 16MB Flash
DIMMs or Optra Forms Hard Disk.
Solaris Ready Solaris Ready printers are specially configured for Sun
users. They are Ethernet-ready and include Sun-specific
documentation as well as MarkVision for Sun Systems
and Intranet Servers. These applications provide seamless
installation in Sun Solaris network environments.
Printers for Sun
Customers
Solaris Ready Printers for Sun Customers
31
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Chapter 2: MarkVision
32
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Using the
Operator Panel
and Menus
3
This chapter contains information about using the
operator panel, changing printer settings, and under-
standing operator panel menus.
You can change most printer settings from your software
application or printer driver. Settings you change from the
application or driver apply only to the job you are prepar-
ing to send to the printer.
If there is a setting you cannot change from your software
application, use the operator panel or the remote operator
Changing a printer setting from the operator panel or
from MarkVision makes that setting the user default.
Note: Changes made to
printer settings from a software
application override changes
made from the operator panel.
If you are familiar with using an operator panel similar to
Using the Operator Panel and Menus
33
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Using the The operator panel, on the front left-side of your printer,
has a 2-line by 16-character liquid crystal display (LCD),
Operator Panel
one printer indicator light, and six buttons. Notice the
Menu button is split into two functioning halves; there-
fore, it works like two buttons.
The numbers on the operator panel by the names of the
buttons are only used for entering your Personal Identifi-
cation Number (PIN) if you send a print job that is confi-
LCD
Menu
Select
Return
Go
Stop
Printer Indicator Light
Printer Indicator
Light
The printer indicator light gives information about the
status of your printer.
Light State
On Solid
Blinking
Off
Meaning
The printer is On (|) and in the Ready state.
The printer is On (|) and Busy.
The printer is Off (O).
Chapter 3: Using the Operator Panel and Menus
34
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Operator Panel
Buttons
Use the operator panel buttons to open a menu, scroll
through a list of values, change printer settings, respond
to printer messages, temporarily stop all print activity,
and key in a PIN. The following table describes the func-
tions of each button.
If this User’s Guide is printed in a language other than
English, an operator panel overlay with translated buttons
information.
Note: Buttons act upon the
information that displays on the
second line of the operator
panel except when using the
buttons to key in a PIN.
Operator Panel Buttons
Button
Go
Function
Press the Go button to:
•
Return to the Ready state if the printer is in an offline situation (the Ready message does not
appear on the display).
•
•
•
•
Exit printer menus and return to the Ready state.
Clear operator panel error messages.
Resume printing after loading print material and clearing paper jams.
Exit Power Saver.
If you have changed printer settings from the operator panel menus, press Go before sending a
job to print. The printer must display Ready for jobs to print.
Menu> and
Each end of the button has a function. Press the Menu> or <Menu button:
<Menu
•
At the Ready message, to take the printer offline (out of the Ready state) and enter the
menus. Menu> takes you to the first menu in the menus. <Menu takes you to the last menu in
the menus.
•
•
At the Busy message, to list the menu items in the JOB MENU.
When the printer is offline:
-
-
Press Menu> to go to the next item in the menus, or
Press <Menu to go to the previous item in the menus.
For menu items that have numerical values, such as Copies, press and hold Menu> to scroll
forward, or <Menu to scroll backward. Release the button when the number you want
displays.
•
Using the Operator Panel
35
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Operator Panel Buttons (continued)
Button
Select
Function
Press the Select button to:
•
Select the menu shown on the second line of the display. Depending on the type of menu, this
action:
-
-
Opens the menu and displays the first item in the menu.
Opens the menu item and displays the default setting.
Save the displayed menu item as the new default setting. The printer displays the Saved
message briefly and returns to the menu item.
•
•
•
Clear certain messages from the operator panel display.
Continue printing after the Change <input source> message displays. See Change <input
Return
Stop
Press the Return button to return to the previous menu level or menu item.
Press the Stop button at the Ready, Busy, or Waiting message to temporarily stop all activity
and take the printer offline. The operator panel status message changes to Not Ready. No data
is lost.
Press Go to return the printer to the Ready, Busy, or Waiting state.
1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6
The numbers located next to the names of the buttons are only used for entering your Personal
Identification Number (PIN) after you send a Confidential Job. For more information, see
Chapter 3: Using the Operator Panel and Menus
36
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Printer Messages The operator panel displays three types of messages:
•
•
•
Status messages provide information about the
current state of the printer.
for a complete listing of all the
printer messages.
Attendance messages report printer errors that you
must resolve.
Service messages indicate printer failures that may
require servicing.
Status Messages
When the Ready status message displays, the printer is
ready to receive a print job. While a job is processing or
printing, the Busy status message or a customized mes-
sage appears on the first line of the operator panel display.
The screen to the left is an example of an operator panel
message. The printer status appears on the first line of the
display. The second line displays messages, such as warn-
ing messages, that give more information about printer
status.
Busy
Parallel
PCL
The Busy message identifies the printer language
(PCL emulation) used for the print job. The Parallel mes-
sage tells you that the printer is processing data received
by the parallel port.
Attendance
Messages
Attendance messages help you solve printer problems.
For example, if print material is jammed in the printer, the
message 200 Paper Jam Remove Cartridge appears on the
display.
This message tells you to open the printer upper front
door and check for jammed print material.
200 Paper Jam
Remove Cartridge
Service Messages
Service messages notify you of printer failures that may
require a service call.
Printer Messages
37
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Operator Panel A number of menus are available to make it easy for you
Menus
the menus and all of the menu items available in each
menu. The items in each menu and the values you can
select are described in more detail in the tables beginning
Some menus appear only if a specific option is installed in
the printer. Other menu items may only be effective for a
particular printer language. You can select these values at
any time, but they only affect printer function when you
use the specified printer language.
An asterisk (*) next to a value in the tables indicates the
factory default setting. These settings are the original printer
settings. (Factory defaults may vary for different coun-
more information.
Note: Changes made from a
software application or driver
override the user default settings
made from the operator panel.
When you select a new setting from the operator panel,
the asterisk moves next to the selected setting to identify it
as the current user default setting. These settings are active
until new ones are stored or the factory defaults are
more information.
Chapter 3: Using the Operator Panel and Menus
38
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Printing the Menu
Settings Page
The menu settings page shows current settings for the
menus, a list of installed options, and available printer
memory. You can use this page to verify that the printer
options are properly installed and the printer settings are
set to what you want.
display and operator panel buttons if you need help.
To print a menu settings page:
Note: Before printing the
menu settings page, make sure
the selected paper source holds
letter-, legal-, or A4-size paper,
the PAPER SIZE setting is set to
the correct size, and the PAPER
TYPE setting for the paper
1 Make sure the printer power is On (| ) and the
Ready status message appears on the display.
2 Press Menu> or <Menu to enter the menus.
3 Continue to press and release Menu> or <Menu until
you see UTILITIES MENU on the second line of the
display.
source is Plain Paper.
4 Press Select.
5 Press Menu> until Print Menus appears on the sec-
ond line of the display.
6 Press Select.
The message Printing Menu Settings appears and
remains on the operator panel display until the
page prints. The printer returns to the Ready state
after the menu settings page prints.
If an error message appears on the display, see
7 If you installed options, verify that they are listed
on the menu settings page under “Installed Fea-
tures.”
If an option you installed does not appear on the
page, turn the printer power Off (O), unplug the
printer power cord, reinstall the option, and print
the menu settings page again.
Operator Panel Menus
39
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Changing
Menu Settings
You can use the operator panel to change printer settings
and customize your printer to meet your specific needs.
To select a new value as the default setting:
1 From the Ready state, press Menu> or <Menu to enter
the menus.
Note: Changes made from a
software application override the
user default settings made from
the operator panel.
2 Continue to press and release Menu> or <Menu until
the menu you need appears on the second line of
the display.
list of the menus and their menu items.
3 Press Select.
The menu opens and the first menu item in the
menu appears on the second line of the display.
4 Press Menu> or <Menu until the menu item you
need appears on the second line of the display.
5 Press Select.
An asterisk (*) appears beside the current user
default setting for that menu item.
Some menu items have submenus. For example, if
you select PAPER MENU, and then select the PAPER
TYPE menu item, you must select another menu
(such as Tray 1 Type) before the available values dis-
play.
A value can be:
– An On or Off setting.
– A phrase or word that describes a setting.
– A numerical value that you can increase or
decrease.
6 Press Menu> or <Menu until the value you need
appears on the second line of the display.
Chapter 3: Using the Operator Panel and Menus
40
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Note: User default settings
remain in effect until you save
new settings or restore the fac-
tory defaults.
7 Press Select.
An asterisk (*) appears beside the value to indicate
that it is now the user default setting. The display
shows the new setting for one second and then
clears. The Saved message displays, then the previ-
ous list of menu items appears on the operator
panel display.
8 Press Return to go back to previous menus or menu
items and set new default settings.
9 Press Go to return to Ready if this is the last printer
setting you want to change.
Disabling the
Operator Panel
Menus
To disable the menus so that changes cannot be made to
the printer default settings:
1 Turn the printer power Off (O).
Note: When the operator
panel menus are disabled,
access to the JOB MENU is per-
mitted from the Ready and Power
Saver states. Access to the CON-
FIDENTIAL JOB and HELD JOBS
menu items is permitted from
the Ready state only.
2 Press and hold the Select and Return buttons and
turn the printer power On (| ).
3 Release the buttons when Performing Self Test
appears on the operator panel display.
When the printer self test completes, the CONFIG
MENU displays.
4 Press Menu> until Panel Menus displays on the sec-
ond line.
5 Press Select.
6 Press Menu> until Disable displays on the second
line of the display.
7 Press Select.
Operator Panel Menus
41
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
8 The Saved message briefly appears, then Disabling
Menus displays.
The CONFIG MENU displays again with Panel Menus
on the second line.
9 Press Menu> until Exit Config Menu displays on the
second line.
10 Press Select.
Activating Menu Changes briefly appears, and then
Performing Self Test briefly appears. The printer
returns to the Ready state.
To enable the menus, repeat the previous steps and select
Enable instead of Disable.
Chapter 3: Using the Operator Panel and Menus
42
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Overview of
Printer Menus
Menus or menu items in italics only appear on the display if the
corresponding option is installed. Capitalized menu items (for
example, PAPER SIZE) have submenus. See the tables on the
following pages for a list of the values for each menu item.
PAPER MENU
FINISHING MENU
UTILITIES MENU
JOB MENU
QUALITY MENU
Paper Source
Copies
Print Menus
Cancel Job
Print Resolution
Toner Darkness
PQET
PAPER SIZE
Blank Pages
Print Net1 Setup
Print Fonts
CONFIDENTIAL JOB
HELD JOBS
PAPER TYPE
Collation
CUSTOM TYPES
Substitute Size
Configure MP
Separator Sheets
Separator Source
Multipage Print
Multipage Order
Multipage View
Multipage Border
Print Directory
Factory Defaults
Format Flash
Defragment Flash
Format Disk
Job Acct Stat
Hex Trace
Reset Printer
Print Buffer
PictureGrade
PAPER TEXTURE
PAPER WEIGHT
PAPER LENGTH
SETUP MENU
PCL EMUL MENU
POSTSCRIPT
MENU (page 83)
PARALLEL MENU
SERIAL MENU
Printer Language
Font Source
Font Name
Print PS Error
Font Priority
STD PARALLEL
SERIAL OPTION 1
1
Power Saver
PARALLEL OPT 1
PCL SmartSwitch
PS SmartSwitch
NPA Mode
Resource Save
Download Target
Print Timeout
Wait Timeout
Auto Continue
Jam Recovery
Page Protect
Point Size
PCL SmartSwitch
PS SmartSwitch
NPA Mode
Parallel Buffer
Job Buffering
Advanced Status
Protocol
Pitch
Symbol Set
Orientation
Lines Per Page
A4 Width
TRAY RENUMBER
Auto CR after LF
Auto LF after CR
Serial Buffer
RS-232/RS-422
RS-422 Polarity
Serial Protocol
Robust XON
Baud
Print Area
Honor Init
2
Display Language
Alarm Control
Job Buffer Size
Job Accounting
Job Acct Limit
Parallel Mode 1
Data Bits
Parallel Mode 2
Parity
Honor DSR
USB MENU
FAX MENU
NETWORK MENU
LOCALTALK MENU
INFRARED MENU
STANDARD USB
USB OPTION 1
Fax Port
NETWORK OPTION 1
LocalTalk Port
PCL SmartSwitch
PS SmartSwitch
NPA Mode
Infrared Port
Fax Baud
PCL SmartSwitch
PS SmartSwitch
NPA Mode
PCL SmartSwitch
PS SmartSwitch
NPA Mode
Network Buffer
Network 1 Setup
Fax Data Bits
Fax Parity
Fax Buffer
Fax Paper Size
Fax Paper Type
PCL SmartSwitch
PS SmartSwitch
NPA Mode
USB Buffer
Job Buffering
LocalTalk Buffer
NPA Hosts
Infrared Buffer
Window Size
Transmit Delay
Max Baud Rate
LocalTalk Name
LocalTalk Addr
LocalTalk Zone
1
CONFIG MENU
Some printer models released in the year 2000 or later designated as Energy Star printers cannot
have Power Saver disabled.
2 Parallel Mode 1 is not supported on the Optra M412 printer.
For all menus:
Prt Quality Pgs
Panel Menus
Buffered Jobs
Factory Defaults
NARROW MEDIA
Exit Config Menu
– Press Menu> or <Menu to enter the menus and scroll through the options.
– Press Select to choose a menu, menu item, or value.
– Press Return to back up to the previous menu level.
For all menus except CONFIG MENU:
– Press Go to return to Ready.
Operator Panel Menus
43
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Paper Menu
Use the PAPER MENU to define all settings relating to
print material input and output, as well as the specific
print material you are using with your printer.
Paper Menu
Menu Item
Values
Paper Source
Tray 1*
Tray 2
MP Feeder
Manual Paper
Manual Env
The Paper Source setting identifies the default paper source.
Select Manual Paper when manually feeding a sheet of print material other than an envelope
through the multipurpose feeder.
Select Manual Env when manually feeding an envelope through the multipurpose feeder.
MP Feeder displays only if Configure MP is set to Cassette. If Paper Source is set to
MP Feeder and Configure MP is set to First, the Paper Source setting automatically changes
to Tray 1.
If you are using the same size and type of print material in two paper sources (and the Paper
Size and Paper Type settings are correctly set), the trays are automatically linked. When one
paper source is empty, print material automatically feeds from the other paper source. See
*Factory default
Chapter 3: Using the Operator Panel and Menus
44
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Paper Menu (continued)
Menu Item
Values
PAPER SIZE
Tray 1 Size
Tray 2 Size
Each of the above menu items support the following values as a second menu:
A4* (Country specific)
JIS B5
Letter* (Country specific)
Legal
Executive
MP Feeder Size
A4* (Country specific)
A5
JIS B5
Letter* (Country specific)
Legal
Executive
Universal
7 ¾ Envelope
9 Envelope
10 Envelope
DL Envelope
C5 Envelope
B5 Envelope
Other Envelope
*Factory default
Operator Panel Menus
45
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Paper Menu (continued)
Menu Item
Values
PAPER SIZE
(continued)
Manual Pap Size
A4* (Country specific)
A5
JIS B5
Letter* (Country specific)
Legal
Executive
Universal
Manual Env Size
7 ¾ Envelope
9 Envelope
10 Envelope* (Country specific)
DL Envelope* (Country specific)
C5 Envelope
B5 Envelope
Other Envelope
The PAPER SIZE setting identifies the default formatting size for each paper source. See the
Note: Before loading print material in any paper source, make sure you select the
PAPER SIZE, PAPER TYPE, PAPER TEXTURE, PAPER WEIGHT, and PAPER LENGTH from
the operator panel for the paper source. Also, select the paper size and type from your
software application for the print material you are loading.
Select Manual Pap Size when manually feeding a single sheet of print material other than an
envelope through the multipurpose feeder.
Select Manual Env Size when manually feeding a single envelope through the multipurpose
feeder.
Universal refers to any size that is not considered a standard size. Select Universal from the
PAPER SIZE menu when you load print material that does not match any of the other available
sizes. The printer automatically formats the page for the maximum possible size. You can then
set the actual page size from your application.
Select Other Envelope from the PAPER SIZE menu when you load envelopes that do not
match any of the other available sizes. The printer automatically formats for the maximum
possible envelope size. You can then set the actual envelope size from your application.
*Factory default
Chapter 3: Using the Operator Panel and Menus
46
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Paper Menu (continued)
Menu Item
Values
PAPER TYPE
Tray 1 Type
Tray 2 Type
Manual Pap Type
Each of the above menu items support the following values as a second menu:
Plain Paper*
Card Stock
Transparency
Labels
Bond
Letterhead
Preprinted
Colored Paper
Custom Type 1
Custom Type 2*
Custom Type 3
Custom Type 4
Custom Type 5
Custom Type 6
Note: Plain Paper is the default setting for Tray 1 Type and Manual Pap Type. Custom Type 2
is the default for Tray 2 Type.
MP Feeder Type
Plain Paper
Card Stock
Transparency
Labels
Bond
Envelope
Letterhead
Preprinted
Colored Paper
Custom Type 1
Custom Type 2
Custom Type 3
Custom Type 4
Custom Type 5
Custom Type 6*
*Factory default
Operator Panel Menus
47
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Paper Menu (continued)
Menu Item
Values
PAPER TYPE
(continued)
Manual Env Type
Envelope*
Custom Type 1
Custom Type 2
Custom Type 3
Custom Type 4
Custom Type 5
Custom Type 6
The PAPER TYPE setting lets you specify the type of print material installed in each paper
source. This setting is used by the printer in the following ways:
•
•
Enables the printer to optimize print quality for the specified print material.
Enables you to select paper sources through your software application by selecting only a
type and size. A source selection is unnecessary.
•
Enables the printer to automatically link paper sources. Any sources that contain the same
type and size of print material are automatically linked by the printer if you have set the
Select Manual Pap Type when manually feeding a single sheet of print material through the
multipurpose feeder.
Select Manual Env Type when manually feeding an envelope through the multipurpose feeder.
Note: Before loading print material in any paper source, make sure you select the
PAPER SIZE, PAPER TYPE, PAPER TEXTURE, PAPER WEIGHT, and PAPER LENGTH from
the operator panel for the paper source. Also, select the paper size and the type from your
application for the print material you are loading.
Custom Type 1 through 6 refers to special types of print materials. You can change the names
through a utility, such as MarkVision. For more information on setting the Custom Type
If you are using different print material in the paper sources, each source with a different print
material must have the PAPER SIZE and PAPER TYPE set to a unique value to disable the
automatic tray linking feature. Otherwise, if a paper source becomes empty, the printer selects
print material from another source since the printer sees the trays as linked. This might cause
page 135 for more information.
*Factory default
Chapter 3: Using the Operator Panel and Menus
48
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Paper Menu (continued)
Menu Item
Values
CUSTOM TYPES
Custom Type x (where x represents a custom type from 1 to 6)
Paper*
Card Stock
Transparency
Labels
Envelope
The CUSTOM TYPES setting identifies the kind of print material used for each of the Custom
Types available in the PAPER TYPE menu item. This print material designation optimizes print
quality settings when you select print material from a paper source when the type is set to
Custom Type x. If a user-defined name is available, the name displays instead of
Custom Type x, where x represents a number 1 through 6. The user-defined name is
truncated to 14 characters.
Substitute Size
Configure MP
Off
Letter/A4*
Select Letter/A4 to let the printer automatically print A4-size jobs on letter-size paper and
letter-size jobs on A4-size paper, if the requested size is not currently installed in the paper
source.
Cassette*
Manual
First
When the multipurpose feeder is set to Cassette and the PAPER SIZE and PAPER TYPE
settings are set correctly, the printer treats the multipurpose feeder like any other paper
source. If a print job requests a size print material that is only loaded in the multipurpose
feeder, the printer selects the print material from the multipurpose feeder for the print job.
Select Manual to manually feed single sheets of print material through the multipurpose
feeder. The multipurpose feeder acts like a manual feed slot and you can feed only one sheet
of print material through at a time.
If you set Configure MP to First, the printer feeds print material from the multipurpose feeder
until it is empty, regardless of the paper source or paper size requested for the job.
*Factory default
Operator Panel Menus
49
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Paper Menu (continued)
Menu Item
Values
PAPER TEXTURE
Plain Texture
Card Stock Text
Trnsprncy Text
Labels Texture
Bond Texture
Envelope Texture
Ltrhead Texture
Preprint Texture
Colored Texture
Custom 1 Texture
Custom 2 Texture
Custom 3 Texture
Custom 4 Texture
Custom 5 Texture
Custom 6 Texture
Each of the above menu items support the following three values as a second menu:
•
•
•
Smooth
Normal*
Rough
Note: Rough is the factory default for Bond Texture.
Select the appropriate PAPER TEXTURE value (Smooth, Normal, or Rough) for each
PAPER TYPE, including the Custom Types, that you are using. Set the correct
PAPER TEXTURE value for your print material to make sure characters print clearly, without
dropouts or voids. If the characters on your printed page appear broken or poorly-formed, set
PAPER TEXTURE to Rough. If characters on your printed page appear smeared, set
PAPER TEXTURE to Smooth or Normal.
The PAPER TEXTURE setting works in connection with the PAPER TYPE and PAPER WEIGHT
settings. You may need to change those settings to optimize print quality for your specific print
material.
If a user-defined texture is available, its name displays as a value instead of
Custom x Texture, where x represents a number 1 through 6. The user-defined name is
truncated to 14 characters.
*Factory default
Chapter 3: Using the Operator Panel and Menus
50
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Paper Menu (continued)
Menu Item
Values
PAPER WEIGHT
Plain Weight
CardStock Weight
Trnsprncy Weight
Labels Weight
Bond Weight
Envelope Weight
Ltrhead Weight
Preprint Weight
Colored Weight
Custom 1 Weight
Custom 2 Weight
Custom 3 Weight
Custom 4 Weight
Custom 5 Weight
Custom 6 Weight
Each of the above menu items support the following three values as a second menu:
•
•
•
Light
Normal*
Heavy
Select the appropriate PAPER WEIGHT value (Light, Normal, or Heavy) for each
PAPER TYPE, including the Custom Types, that you are using. Set the correct
PAPER WEIGHT value for your print material to make sure the toner adheres properly to the
page. If you have trouble with toner rubbing off the page, set PAPER WEIGHT to Heavy. If your
printed pages are curling excessively, set PAPER WEIGHT to Normal or Light.
The PAPER WEIGHT setting works in connection with the PAPER TYPE and PAPER TEXTURE
settings. You may need to change those settings to optimize print quality for your specific print
material.
If a user-defined weight is available, its name displays as a value instead of Custom x Weight,
where x represents a number 1 through 6. The user-defined name is truncated to 14
characters.
*Factory default
Operator Panel Menus
51
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Paper Menu (continued)
Menu Item
Values
PAPER LENGTH
Plain Length
CardStock Length
Trnsprncy Length
Labels Length
Bond Length
Envelope Length
Ltrhead Length
Preprint Length
Colored Length
Custom 1 Length
Custom 2 Length
Custom 3 Length
Custom 4 Length
Custom 5 Length
Custom 6 Length
Each of the above menu items support the following values as a second menu:
•
•
Short
Normal*
Select the appropriate PAPER LENGTH value (Normal or Short) for each printer paper type.
Set the PAPER LENGTH value to Short if your print material is 152.4 mm (6 in.) or less in
length. Set the PAPER LENGTH value to Normal for all other print material.
Print material 152.4 mm (6 in.) or less in length can only be fed through the multipurpose
feeder and must exit to the rear output bin.
Note: If PAPER LENGTH is set to Short and the rear output bin door is not open, your job will
If a user-defined length is available, its name displays as a value instead of Custom x Length,
where x represents a number 1 through 6. The user-defined name is truncated to 14
characters.
*Factory default
Chapter 3: Using the Operator Panel and Menus
52
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Finishing Menu
Use the FINISHING MENU to define all settings relating
to printer output.
Finishing Menu
Menu Item
Values
Copies
1*…999
The Copies setting determines the number of copies printed for each page. The printer does
not automatically collate the copies. For example, if you send three pages to print and set
Copies to 2, the printer prints page 1, page 1, page 2, page 2, page 3, page 3.
For information about how to use the Copies setting with the Collation setting, see Collation
as follows.
Blank Pages
Do Not Print*
Print
Select Print to include application-generated blank pages with your print job.
Select Do Not Print if you do not want the printer to print any application-generated blank
pages that appear in your document.
Collation
Off*
On
When Collation is set to Off, the printer prints each page of a job the number of times as
specified by the Copies setting. For example, if you send three pages to print and set Copies
to 2, the printer prints page 1, page 1, page 2, page 2, page 3, page 3.
When Collation is set to On, the printer prints the entire job the number of times as specified
by the Copies setting. For example, if you send three pages to print and set Copies to 2, the
printer prints page 1, page 2, page 3, page 1, page 2, page 3.
Many applications collate documents by repeatedly sending the file to the printer. As a result,
the printer must process each print job until the correct number of copies has printed. This
requires additional time since the printer must process the same pages over again. By using
Collation, the printer processes the file only once, saves the file in printer memory, and prints
the multiple copies. This saves processing time for the printer and for the application, and
overall printing time may be reduced.
For Collation to work effectively, your software application must recognize this printer feature
and not send the job to the printer multiple times. Your application must also let you specify
the number of copies needed or let you use the printer default setting for Copies.
Select Collation from the operator panel or from the printer driver. For best results, select
Collated in the printer driver and set the number of copies to one. In your application, select
Uncollated (if the option is available) and then select the number of copies you want.
If the job is complex or exceeds the memory capacity of your printer, you may receive a
37 Insufficient Collation Area message. Press Go to clear the message. The printer collates
the remaining pages in memory. If you reset the printer, the printer discards the job. See
*Factory default
Operator Panel Menus
53
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Finishing Menu (continued)
Menu Item
Values
Separator Sheets
None*
Between Copies
Between Jobs
Between Pages
You can have the printer insert blank separator sheets between jobs, between multiple copies
of a job, or between each page of a job. Separator sheets are pulled from the source specified
in the Separator Source menu item.
Select Between Copies for multiple copy jobs. If Collation is set to Off, a blank page is
inserted between sets of each printed page. If Collation is set to On, a blank page is inserted
between each copy of the job.
Select Between Jobs to insert a blank page after each print job. This may be helpful when
several people are using the printer.
Select Between Pages to insert a blank page between each page of a job. This is useful if you
are printing transparencies and want to reduce static build-up when stacking transparencies
in the output bin.
Separator Source
Tray 1*
Tray 2
MP Feeder
If you are using separator sheets, Separator Source lets you specify the paper source that
holds the separator sheets.
Only installed paper sources display as values. You can only select MP Feeder as the
separator source if Configure MP is set to Cassette. If Separator Source is set to MP Feeder
and Configure MP is set to First, the Separator Source setting automatically changes to
Multipage Print
Off*
2-Up
3-Up
4-Up
6-Up
9-Up
12-Up
16-Up
Use the Multipage Print (N-up) setting to print multiple page images on a single page. For
example, 2-Up means two page images are printed on one page, 3-Up means three page
images are printed on one page, and so forth.
The printer uses the Multipage Order, Multipage View, and Multipage Border settings to
determine the order and orientation of the page images and if a border is printed around each
page image.
Printer setting changes within a print job may affect the results you get when using
Multipage Print.
*Factory default
Chapter 3: Using the Operator Panel and Menus
54
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Finishing Menu (continued)
Menu Item
Values
Multipage Order
Horizontal*
Vertical
Rev Horizontal
Rev Vertical
The Multipage Order setting determines the positioning of multiple page images on pages
printed using Multipage Print. You may choose one of four different orders. The positioning of
page images depends on if the pages are sent to the printer as portrait or landscape images.
The following examples show the result of using each Multipage Order setting on a 4-Up print
job.
Horizontal
Portrait Landscape
Vertical
Landscape
Portrait
Page 1
Page 1
Page 2
Page 3
Page 3 Page 4
Page 2 Page 4
Rev Horizontal
Portrait Landscape
Rev Vertical
Portrait Landscape
Page 2
Page 1
Page 3
Page 1
Page 4 Page 3
Page 4 Page 2
*Factory default
Operator Panel Menus
55
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Finishing Menu (continued)
Menu Item
Values
Multipage View
Auto*
Long Edge
Short Edge
Use the Multipage View setting to select the orientation of the printed page with respect to the
page images during Multipage Print.
Select Auto to allow the printer to choose between portrait and landscape positioning.
Select Long Edge to position the long edge of the print material as the top of the page.
Select Short Edge to position the short edge of the print material as the top of the page.
Note: For PostScript 3 emulation print jobs, the Auto setting is always in portrait orientation.
Multipage Border
None*
Solid
Use the Multipage Border setting to specify if a border is printed around each page image
during Multipage Print.
Select None if you do not want to print a border around each page image.
Select Solid to print a solid line border around each page image.
*Factory default
Chapter 3: Using the Operator Panel and Menus
56
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Utilities Menu
Use the UTILITIES MENU to print a variety of listings
relating to available printer resources, printer settings, and
print jobs. Additional menu items let you set up printer
hardware and troubleshoot printer problems.
Utilities Menu
Menu Item
Values
Print Menus
Press Select to print the menu settings page.
The menu settings page is a list of the user default settings, the installed options, and the
amount of available printer memory. This list also shows you the order of menu items.
Note: The menu settings page must be printed on letter-, legal-, or A4-size paper.
Print Net1 Setup
Print Fonts
Press Select to print the internal print server settings page.
The internal print server settings page contains information on your network setup and the
printer settings for your network as defined by the Network 1 Setup menu item in the
Note: Print Net1 Setup displays only if an internal print server is installed in your printer.
PCL Fonts
PS Fonts
Press Select to print a font sample list that shows all the fonts currently available in the
Print Directory
Press Select to print a list of all the resources stored in flash memory or on the hard disk
option.
The Print Directory menu item is available only if at least one of the options is installed and
formatted. Refer to the Technical Reference for details.
Factory Defaults
Restore
Do Not Restore
If you choose Restore:
•
All downloaded resources (fonts, macros, symbol sets) in printer memory (RAM) are
deleted. (Resources residing in flash memory or on the hard disk option are unaffected.)
All menu settings are returned to the factory default values except:
•
– Display Language (SETUP MENU) which is the operator panel display language.
– All settings in the PARALLEL MENU, SERIAL MENU, NETWORK MENU, INFRARED
MENU, LOCALTALK MENU, USB MENU, and FAX MENU.
The message Restoring Factory Defaults briefly appears while the printer restores the factory
Operator Panel Menus
57
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Utilities Menu (continued)
Menu Item
Values
Format Flash
Yes
No
Formatting the flash memory option deletes all resources (fonts, macros, symbol sets) stored
in flash memory and prepares the flash memory card to receive new resources.
The Format Flash menu item only displays if the installed flash memory option is not defective
or Read/Write or Write protected. 51 Defective Flash may display when the printer is turned
information.
Warning: If you select Format Flash and press Go, any data stored in flash memory is lost.
Do not turn off the printer while the flash is formatting.
Defragment Flash
Yes
No
Defragmenting the flash memory option transfers all undeleted resources stored in flash
memory to printer memory and then reformats the flash memory option. When the format
operation is complete, the undeleted resources are loaded back into flash memory.
The Defragment Flash menu item only displays if the installed flash memory option is not
defective or Read/Write or Write protected. 51 Defective Flash may display when the printer is
for more information.
37 Insufficient Defrag Memory displays if printer memory is too full to perform the Flash
information.
Warning: Do not turn off the printer while the flash is defragmenting.
Format Disk
Yes
No
Formatting the hard disk option deletes all resources stored on the hard disk and prepares it
to receive new resources.
The Format Disk menu item only displays if the installed hard disk option is not defective or
Read/Write or Write protected. 61 Defective Disk may display when the printer is turned on, or
mation.
Format Disk does not display if Job Buffer Size is set to 100%. See Job Buffer Size on
page 77 for more information.
Warning: If you select Format Disk and press Go, any data stored on the hard disk option is
lost. Do not turn off the printer while the hard disk is formatting.
Chapter 3: Using the Operator Panel and Menus
58
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Utilities Menu (continued)
Menu Item
Values
Job Acct Stat
Print
Clear
The Job Acct Stat menu item only displays if a hard disk option is installed in your printer and
is not defective or Read/Write or Write protected. Job Accounting in the SETUP MENU must
be set to On.
Select Print to print a list of statistics for a defined number of the most recent print jobs. (The
number of jobs is determined by the value of the Job Acct Limit menu item in the
SETUP MENU). The statistics include if the job printed with or without errors, the time required
to print the job, the size (in bytes) of the job, the requested paper size and paper type, the total
number of printed pages, and the number of copies requested.
Select Clear to delete all accumulated job statistics from the hard disk option. Clearing Job
Accounting Stat displays until the process completes. See Clearing Job Accounting Stat on
page 152 for more information.
Hex Trace
Press Select to enter Hex Trace mode.
Hex Trace helps isolate the source of a print job problem. With Hex Trace selected, all data
sent to the printer is printed in hexadecimal and character representation. Control codes are
not run.
To exit Hex Trace, turn the printer power Off (O), or reset the printer. To reset the printer, press
Menu> or <Menu. JOB MENU displays. Press Menu> or <Menu until Reset Printer appears on
the second line of the operator panel display. Press Select.
Note: Resetting the printer deletes all current data from the print buffer, including all Print and
Job Menu
Some JOB MENU menu items are available when the
printer displays the Ready message and is idle since it is
not accepting, formatting, or printing a job. Other menu
items in JOB MENU are only available when the printer is
busy processing or printing a job, when a printer message
other than Ready displays, or when the printer is in Hex
Trace mode.
Note: For documentation pur-
poses, Print and Hold jobs refers
to any of the following jobs: Con-
fidential Job, Reserve Print Job,
Repeat Print Job, and Verify
more information on Print and
Hold jobs.
Operator Panel Menus
59
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Job Menu
Menu Item
Values
Cancel Job
Press Select to cancel the current print job.
Cancel Job displays only when the printer is processing a print job.
CONFIDENTIAL
JOB
Enter PIN
Once a correct Personal Identification Number (PIN) is entered, the following values are
This menu item is
JOB MENU until the
printer has
processed at least
one Confidential
Job.
Print All Jobs
PRINT A JOB
<Job #1 Username> <Job #1 Jobname>
<Job #2 Username> <Job #2 Jobname>
<Job #3 Username> <Job #3 Jobname>
...
Note: Use your
software application
or printer driver to
create and send a
Confidential Job.
<Job #n Username> <Job #n Jobname>
Delete All Jobs
DELETE A JOB
<Job #1 Username> <Job #1 Jobname>
<Job #2 Username> <Job #2 Jobname>
<Job #3 Username> <Job #3 Jobname>
...
<Job #n Username> <Job #n Jobname>
PRINT COPIES
<Job #1 Username> <Job #1 Jobname>
<Job #2 Username> <Job #2 Jobname>
<Job #3 Username> <Job #3 Jobname>
...
<Job #n Username> <Job #n Jobname>
Note: In the sub-menu values listed above, the Username field is based on the username
field in your driver. By default, this is the user name or user ID you type to log on to your
operating system. You can change the name in this field to another name in the driver before
you send the job. The Jobname field contains a title name for your file as defined by your
application software when the job was sent. You cannot change this field. If one or both of the
fields is empty, the name was not defined by the application. For example, if your last name is
Smith and your file is called timesheet, the operator panel may display smith timesheet. The
Username and Jobname fields are truncated to 16 characters.
When you create a Confidential Job, the printer formats your job and holds the job in memory.
The printer delays the printing of your job until you enter a PIN assigned to the job. You enter
on page 111 for more information.
Chapter 3: Using the Operator Panel and Menus
60
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Job Menu (continued)
Menu Item
Values
CONFIDENTIAL
JOB
Once a valid PIN is entered, the operator panel displays:
(continued)
CONFIDENTIAL JOB
Print All Jobs
You have several print or delete options to choose from:
•
•
•
•
•
print all jobs
print a job
print copies
delete all jobs
delete a job
Press Menu> or <Menu until the menu item you need appears on the second line of the
display.
Press Select.
While in the values for this menu item, the following button actions are possible:
•
•
•
Press Go to exit the selection and the menu group, and return to the previous screen.
Press Menu> or <Menu to choose the next or previous option in the list.
Press Return to exit the operation, but remain in the JOB MENU or to return to the previous
screen after scrolling through a list of print jobs.
Note: While in the CONFIDENTIAL JOB menu item, you can make selections in both PRINT A
JOB and DELETE A JOB values. Then, both actions occur when you press Go to exit the JOB
MENU.
Operator Panel Menus
61
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Job Menu (continued)
Menu Item
Values
CONFIDENTIAL
JOB
(continued)
Print All Jobs
If you press Select to choose this value, printing starts and the operator panel exits this
operation.
All Confidential Jobs associated with your assigned PIN are printed.
PRINT A JOB
If you press Select to choose this value, a list of jobs available for printing is displayed. The
first job is displayed on the second line.
PRINT A JOB
<Job #1 Username> <Job #1 Jobname>
All Confidential Jobs associated with your assigned PIN are listed. Use Menu> or <Menu to
scroll through the list of available jobs.
PRINT A JOB
<Job #2 Username> <Job #2 Jobname>
Press Menu> or <Menu to scroll to the job you want to print. When the job is on the second
line of the display, press Select to mark the job for printing. An asterisk (*) appears to mark the
job for printing. You may select additional jobs to print by marking them with an asterisk.
Note: If you make a mistake and mark the wrong job, press Select again to unmark the job.
The asterisk beside the print job is removed.
When a job has been marked for printing, the job is removed from the list of available print
Press Return until you exit the menus or press Go to exit the menus. The message Queuing
Jobs displays; however, the message Queuing and Deleting Jobs displays if you previously
selected some print jobs for deletion. Once the printer exits the menus and returns to an
online state, the job starts printing. For more information, see Queuing Jobs and Queuing and
Deleting Jobs on page 156.
Chapter 3: Using the Operator Panel and Menus
62
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Job Menu (continued)
Menu Item
Values
CONFIDENTIAL
JOB
(continued)
Delete All Jobs
If you press Select to choose this value, the message Delete All Jobs. Go/Stop? displays. You
have one chance to stop the deletion of all the confidential jobs associated with your PIN.
Note: All Confidential Jobs associated with your assigned PIN are deleted.
Press Stop if you do not want to delete all jobs. The operator panel returns to the following
screen, and you may choose to exit the CONFIDENTIAL JOB menu item or scroll to another
value using Menu> or <Menu.
CONFIDENTIAL JOB
Delete All Jobs
Press Go to delete all jobs. The message Deleting Jobs displays. The jobs are deleted and
the printer exits the menus.
DELETE A JOB
If you press Select to choose this value, a list of jobs held in printer memory is displayed as
shown. The first job is displayed on the second line.
DELETE A JOB
<Job #1 Username> <Job #1 Jobname>
All Confidential Jobs associated with your assigned PIN are listed. Use Menu> or <Menu to
scroll through the list of available jobs.
DELETE A JOB
<Job #2 Username> <Job #2 Jobname>
Press Menu> or <Menu to scroll to the job you want to delete. When the job is on the second
line of the display, press Select to mark a job for deletion. An asterisk (*) appears to mark the
job for deletion. You may select additional jobs to delete by marking them with an asterisk.
Note: If you make a mistake and mark the wrong job, press Select again to unmark the job.
The asterisk beside the print job is removed.
When a job has been marked for deletion, the job is removed from the list of available print
Press Return until you exit the menus or press Go to exit the menus. Once the printer exits the
menus and returns to an online state, the jobs you selected are deleted. The message
Deleting Jobs displays; however, the message Queuing and Deleting Jobs displays if you
previously selected some jobs to print. For more information, see Deleting Jobs and Queuing
and Deleting Jobs on page 153.
Operator Panel Menus
63
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Job Menu (continued)
Menu Item
Values
CONFIDENTIAL
JOB
(continued)
PRINT COPIES
If you press Select to choose this value, a list of jobs held in printer memory is displayed as
shown. The first job is displayed on the second line.
PRINT COPIES
<Job #1 Username> <Job #1 Jobname>
All Confidential Jobs associated with your assigned PIN are listed. Use Menu> or <Menu to
scroll through the list of available jobs.
PRINT COPIES
<Job #2 Username> <Job #2 Jobname>
You may select one or more jobs to print and you may change the number of copies for each
job to be printed.
Press Menu> or <Menu to scroll to the one job you want to print. When the job is on the
second line of the display, press Select.
The following prompt displays:
Copies
=x*
The setting for the current number of copies is indicated by the asterisk (*). Press Menu> or
<Menu to increase or decrease the number of copies as specified by the x value. You may
choose to print from 1 to 999 copies of a single job at a time.
Press Select to save the setting for the number of copies you need. The Saved message
displays and then the list of jobs displays. An asterisk (*) appears beside the job name to
indicate it is selected for printing. You may select other jobs to print and change the number of
copies required.
When a job has been marked for printing, the job is removed from the list of available print
When you finish making selections and change the number of copies, press Return until you
exit the menus or press Go to exit the menus. The message Queuing Jobs displays; however,
the message Queuing and Deleting Jobs displays if you previously selected some jobs for
deletion. Once the printer exits the menus and returns to an online state, the remaining copies
print. Once all copies are printed, the job is deleted from printer memory. For more infor-
Chapter 3: Using the Operator Panel and Menus
64
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Job Menu (continued)
Menu Item
Values
HELD JOBS
Print All Jobs
PRINT A JOB
This menu item is
not displayed in the
JOB MENU until the
printer has
processed at least
one Repeat Print,
Reserve Print, or
Verify Print job.
<Job #1 Username> <Job #1 Jobname>
<Job #2 Username> <Job #2 Jobname>
<Job #3 Username> <Job #3 Jobname>
...
<Job #n Username> <Job #n Jobname>
Delete All Jobs
DELETE A JOB
Note: Use your
software application
or printer driver to
create and send a
Repeat Print,
Reserve Print, or
Verify Print job.
<Job #1 Username> <Job #1 Jobname>
<Job #2 Username> <Job #2 Jobname>
<Job #3 Username> <Job #3 Jobname>
...
<Job #n Username> <Job #n Jobname>
PRINT COPIES
<Job #1 Username> <Job #1 Jobname>
<Job #2 Username> <Job #2 Jobname>
<Job #3 Username> <Job #3 Jobname>
...
<Job #n Username> <Job #n Jobname>
Note: In the sub-menu values listed above, the Username field is based on the username
field in your driver. By default, this is the user name or user ID you type in to log on to your
operating system. You can change the name in this field to another name in the driver before
you send the job. The Jobname field contains a title name for your file as defined by your
application software when the job was sent. You cannot change this field. If one or both of the
fields is empty, the name was not defined by the application. For example, if your last name is
Smith and your file is called timesheet, the operator panel may display smith timesheet. The
Username and Jobname fields are truncated to 16 characters.
Unlike a Confidential Job, you do not enter a PIN to access the values once you enter the
HELD JOBS menu item.
When you create a Repeat Print job, the job formats and prints, but the printer stores the job
in memory so you can print additional copies of the job at a later time. As long as the job
remains stored in memory, you may print additional copies. Repeat Jobs are automatically
deleted when the printer requires extra memory to process additional jobs or when the
number of Repeat Jobs stored exceeds the value of the set limit for Print and Hold Repeat
Job Limit. For more information about this setting, refer to the Technical Reference.
When you create a Reserve Print job, the job formats, but does not print. The printer stores
the job in memory so you can print the job at a later time. All pages in the job are held in
memory until you activate printing by using the operator panel to select Print All Jobs or
PRINT A JOB. Reserve Print jobs are not deleted from memory when the job prints. To delete
a Reserve Print job, you must request DELETE A JOB using the operator panel.
Operator Panel Menus
65
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Job Menu (continued)
Menu Item
Values
HELD JOBS
(continued)
When you create a Verify Print job, the job formats, and one copy of the job prints. Additional
requested copies are held in printer memory. You specify the number of copies you want
when you send the job from the printer driver. This allows you to examine the first copy to be
sure it is satisfactory before you print the other copies.
If the job is unsatisfactory, you would not want the other copies to print. Select the
information.
To print the remaining copies, you can:
•
Change the number of remaining copies to print. Select PRINT COPIES. Select the specific
job. At the Copies prompt, change the number of copies to print from the number set in the
printer driver and press Select. Press Return until you exit the menus or press Go to exit
the menus. Once the printer exits the menus and returns to an online state, the remaining
copies print. Once all copies are printed, the job is deleted from printer memory. For more
•
Print the number of copies set in the printer driver. Select PRINT A JOB. Select the specific
job. The remaining copies print. Once all copies are printed, the job is deleted from printer
Once you select HELD JOBS, the operator panel displays:
HELD JOBS
Print All Jobs
You have several print or delete options to choose from:
•
•
•
•
•
print all jobs
print a job
print copies
delete all jobs
delete a job
Press Menu> or <Menu until the menu item you need appears on the second line of the
display.
Press Select.
While in the values for this menu item, the following button actions are possible:
•
•
•
Press Go to exit the selection, the menu group, and return to the previous screen.
Press Menu> or <Menu to choose the next or previous option in the list.
Press Return to exit the operation, but remain in the JOB MENU or to return to the previous
screen after scrolling through a list of print jobs.
Note: While in the HELD JOBS menu item, you can make selections in both
PRINT A JOB and DELETE A JOB values. Then, both actions occur when you press Go to exit
the JOB MENU.
Chapter 3: Using the Operator Panel and Menus
66
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Job Menu (continued)
Menu Item
Values
Print All Jobs
HELD JOBS
(continued)
If you press Select to choose this value, printing starts and the operator panel exits this
operation.
All Repeat Print, Reserve Print, and Verify Print jobs are printed.
PRINT A JOB
If you press Select to choose this value, a list of jobs available for printing is displayed. The
first job is displayed on the second line.
PRINT A JOB
<Job #1 Username> <Job #1 Jobname>
All Repeat Print, Reserve Print, and Verify Print jobs are listed. Use Menu> or <Menu to scroll
through the list of available jobs.
PRINT A JOB
<Job #2 Username> <Job #2 Jobname>
Press Menu> or <Menu to scroll to the one job you want to print. When the job is on the
second line of the display, press Select to mark a job for printing. An asterisk (*) appears to
mark the job for printing. You may select additional jobs to print by marking them with an
asterisk.
Note: If you make a mistake and mark the wrong job, press Select again to unmark the job.
The asterisk beside the print job is removed.
When a job has been marked for printing, the job is removed from the list of available print
Press Return until you exit the menus or press Go to exit the menus. The message Queuing
Jobs displays; however, the message Queuing and Deleting Jobs displays if you previously
selected some jobs for deletion. Once the printer exits the menus and returns to an online
state, the jobs you selected start printing. For more information, see Queuing Jobs and
Queuing and Deleting Jobs on page 156.
Operator Panel Menus
67
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Job Menu (continued)
Menu Item
Values
HELD JOBS
(continued)
Delete All Jobs
If you press Select to choose this value, the message Delete All Jobs. Go/Stop? displays so
you have one chance to stop the deletion of all the print jobs you have sent.
Note: All Repeat Print, Reserve Print, and Verify Print jobs will be deleted.
Press Stop if you do not want to delete all jobs. The operator panel returns to the following
screen, and you may choose to exit the CONFIDENTIAL JOB menu item or scroll to another
value using Menu> or <Menu.
CONFIDENTIAL JOB
Delete All Jobs
Press Go to delete all jobs. The message Deleting Jobs displays. The jobs are deleted and
the printer exits the menus.
DELETE A JOB
If you press Select to choose this value, a list of jobs held in printer memory is displayed as
shown. The first job is displayed on the second line.
DELETE A JOB
<Job #1 Username> <Job #1 Jobname>
All Repeat Print, Reserve Print, and Verify Print jobs are listed. Use Menu> or <Menu to scroll
through the list of available jobs.
DELETE A JOB
<Job #2 Username> <Job #2 Jobname>
Press Menu> or <Menu to scroll to the one job you want to delete. When the job you want to
delete is on the second line of the display, press Select to mark a job for deletion. An asterisk
(*) appears to mark the job for deletion. You may select additional jobs to delete by marking
them with an asterisk.
Note: If you make a mistake and mark the wrong job, press Select again to unmark the job.
The asterisk beside the job is removed.
When a job has been marked for deletion, the job is removed from the list of available jobs in
Press Return until you exit the menus or press Go to exit the menus. Once the printer exits the
menus and returns to an online state, the job is deleted. The message Deleting Jobs displays;
however, the message Queuing and Deleting Jobs displays if you previously selected some
Chapter 3: Using the Operator Panel and Menus
68
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Job Menu (continued)
Menu Item
Values
HELD JOBS
(continued)
PRINT COPIES
If you press Select to choose this value, a list of jobs held in printer memory is displayed as
shown. The first job is displayed on the second line.
PRINT COPIES
<Job #1 Username> <Job #1 Jobname>
All Repeat Print, Reserve Print, and Verify Print jobs are listed. Use Menu> or <Menu to scroll
through the list of available jobs.
PRINT COPIES
<Job #2 Username> <Job #2 Jobname>
You may select one or more jobs to print and you may change the number of copies for each
job to be printed.
Press Menu> or <Menu to scroll to the job you want to print. When the job is on the second
line of the display, press Select.
The following prompt displays:
Copies
=x*
The setting for the current number of copies is indicated by the asterisk (*). Press Menu> or
<Menu to increase or decrease the number of copies as specified by the x value. You may
choose to print from 1 to 999 copies of a single job at a time.
Note: You specify a certain number when you send a Verify Print Job. For more information,
Press Select to save the setting for the number of copies you need. The Saved message
displays and then the list of jobs displays. There is now an asterisk beside the job name to
indicate it is selected for printing. You may select other jobs to print and change the number of
copies required.
When a job has been marked for printing, the job is removed from the list of available jobs in
When you are finished making selections and changing the number of copies, press Return
until you exit the menus or press Go to exit the menus. The message Queuing Jobs displays;
however, the message Queuing and Deleting Jobs displays if you previously selected some
jobs for deletion. Once the printer exits the menus and returns to an online state, the
remaining copies print. For more information, see Queuing Jobs and Queuing and Deleting
Operator Panel Menus
69
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Job Menu (continued)
Menu Item
Values
Reset Printer
Press Select to reset the printer.
Note: Before selecting Reset Printer, exit the software application you are using.
When you select Reset Printer, the printer resets to the user default setting for each menu
item. All downloaded resources (fonts, macros, symbol sets) in printer memory (RAM) are
deleted. All data on the currently selected host interface is deleted from the interface link
buffer. All Print and Hold jobs are deleted.
Print Buffer
Press Select to print any data stored in the print buffer.
This menu item is only available when you enter the JOB MENU while the Waiting message is
displayed. The Waiting state occurs if an incomplete job is sent to the printer or if an ASCII job
is being printed. Examples include sending a print screen command from your host computer
or copying a DOS file.
Chapter 3: Using the Operator Panel and Menus
70
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Quality Menu
Use the QUALITY MENU to change settings affecting the
quality of the printed characters and images.
Quality Menu
Menu Item
Values
Print Resolution
300 dpi
600 dpi*
1200 Image Q
The Print Resolution setting defines the number of dots printed per inch (dpi). The higher the
setting, the sharper the clarity of printed characters and graphics.
If your print jobs are mostly text, select 600 dpi for the highest quality output. Select
1200 Image Q (1200 Image Quality) when your job contains bitmapped images, such as
scanned photos or some business graphics, that will benefit from enhanced line screening.
Toner Darkness
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8*
9
10
Use the Toner Darkness menu item to lighten or darken the image appearance in your print
jobs and get the most from your toner supply.
If you want finer line width, higher definition in graphics, and lighter gray-scale images, set
Toner Darkness to 6 or 7.
If you want a bolder line width, emphasis in graphics, or darker gray-scale images, set
Toner Darkness to 9 or 10. Use the 10 value to emphasize line width, produce the boldest text,
and the darkest images.
If you want to help conserve the printer toner supply, use the 1 to 5 values.
*Factory default
Operator Panel Menus
71
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Quality Menu (continued)
Menu Item
Values
Toner Darkness
(continued)
When you first enter Toner Darkness, the operator panel displays:
Toner Darkness
=8 -.......v..+*
Notice the periods (.) displayed across the second line of the operator panel. Each period
represents one of the numbers 1 through 10 from left to right. A symbol like a v or an arrow
points to the location of the 8 value, which is the factory default.
A minus sign (-) at the left end of the string of periods indicates you are scrolling to the lower
numbers in the string. A plus sign (+) at the right end of the string of periods indicates you are
scrolling to the higher numbers in the string. If you decide to change the setting to 6, for
example, use <Menu to scroll back to the 6.
Toner Darkness
=6 -.....v.|..+
As you scroll backward toward the minus sign (-) indicating lower numbers, notice the v or
arrow symbol moves on the operator panel as you press the <Menu button. It now appears in
place of the sixth period. Notice the numeral 6 displays next to the equal sign to indicate your
selection. A vertical bar (|) indicates the factory default of 8. The vertical bar remains at 8
unless 8 is selected. Then, the arrow covers the vertical bar.
Press Select to select 6 as your current setting. The Saved message displays.
PQET
Off
On*
When printed characters appear to have jagged or uneven edges, set PQET (Print Quality
Enhancement Technology) to On to improve the print quality of your text and make the
characters appear smoother.
PictureGrade
Off
On*
Use the PictureGrade™ menu item to improve the quality of gray-scale printing at 300 and
600 dpi resolutions in PostScript 3 emulation.
If you select Off, the printer uses the standard screening parameters. If you select On,
different default screening parameters are used to improve the print quality of graphics.
*Factory default
Chapter 3: Using the Operator Panel and Menus
72
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Setup Menu
Use the SETUP MENU to configure a variety of printer
features.
Setup Menu
Menu Item
Values
Printer Language
PCL Emulation*
PS Emulation
The printer language defines how the computer communicates with the printer. Your computer
uses printer languages, such as PCL emulation and PostScript 3 emulation, to send print data
to the printer. Setting a printer language as the default does not prevent the software appli-
cation from sending print jobs that use the other printer language.
Power Saver
Disabled
1…120 (20*) [Optra M410]
1…240 (15*) [Optra M412]
The Power Saver menu item lets you reduce power usage when the printer is idle by deter-
mining the length of time (in minutes) the printer waits after a job is printed before it goes to a
reduced power state.
If you have selected a Power Saver value, the Power Saver message replaces the Ready
message and becomes the new printer default when the printer is in a Ready state. Both
messages indicate the printer is ready to receive jobs.
If your printer is in constant use, select a high setting, such as 120. Under most circum-
stances, this keeps the printer ready to print with minimum warm-up time. However, a high
setting also uses more energy.
Set Power Saver to 1 to put the printer in Power Saver mode one minute after it finishes a print
job. This uses much less energy, but requires more warm-up time for the printer. If your printer
shares an electrical circuit with room lighting and you notice lights flickering, you may want to
set Power Saver to 1.
If you want a balance between energy consumption and a shorter warm-up period, select a
Power Saver value between 1 and 120 minutes or 1 and 240 minutes depending on your
printer model.
Note: Some printer models released in the year 2000 or later designated as Energy Star
printers cannot have Power Saver disabled.
Resource Save
Off*
On
The Resource Save setting determines what the printer does with downloaded resources,
such as fonts and macros, if it receives a job that requires more memory than is available.
If Resource Save is set to On, the printer retains all permanent downloaded resources for all
printer languages during language changes and printer resets. If the printer runs out of
memory, Memory Full appears on the operator panel display.
If Resource Save is set to Off, the printer retains permanent downloaded resources only until
memory is needed. Then it deletes those resources stored for the inactive printer language.
*Factory default
Operator Panel Menus
73
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Setup Menu (continued)
Menu Item
Values
Download Target
RAM*
Flash
Disk
The Download Target menu item specifies the storage location for downloaded resources,
such as fonts and macros.
Storing downloaded resources in flash memory or hard disk is permanent storage rather than
the temporary storage that RAM provides. You can add resources to flash memory or to the
hard disk until the option is full. Use your software application or the printer Toolkit to
download resources to the printer.
The Download Target menu item only displays if a formatted flash memory option or hard disk
option is installed in the printer and is not defective or Read/Write or Write protected.
51 Defective Flash or 61 Defective Disk may display when the printer is turned on, or during
page 165 for more information.
Disk does not display for Download Target if Job Buffer Size is set to 100%. See Job Buffer
If neither option is installed, Download Target does not display and all downloaded resources
are automatically stored in printer memory (RAM).
Print Timeout
Disabled
1…255 (90*)
The Print Timeout setting determines the time (in seconds) the printer waits before printing
the last page of a print job that does not end with a command to print the page. The print
timeout counter does not start until the Waiting message displays.
When a print timeout occurs, the printer stores the page in the print buffer.
Select Disabled to turn Print Timeout off. When Print Timeout is disabled, the printer does not
print the last page of a print job until one of the following occurs:
•
•
•
The printer receives enough information to fill the page.
The printer receives a Form Feed command.
Wait Timeout
Disabled
15…65535 (40*)
The Wait Timeout setting determines the amount of time (in seconds) the printer waits to
receive additional bytes of data from the computer. When this timeout expires, the print job is
canceled.
Select Disabled to turn Wait Timeout off.
Wait Timeout is only available when using PostScript 3 emulation. The setting has no effect
on PCL emulation print jobs.
*Factory default
Chapter 3: Using the Operator Panel and Menus
74
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Setup Menu (continued)
Menu Item
Values
Auto Continue
Disabled*
5…255
Set Auto Continue to a value between 5 seconds and 255 seconds to have the printer
continue printing after it detects one of the following errors:
34 Short Paper
35 Res Save Off Deficient Memory
37 Insufficient Collation Area
37 Insufficient Defrag Memory
37 Insufficient Memory
38 Memory Full
39 Complex Page
51 Defective Flash
52 Flash Full
53 Unformatted Flash
54 Serial Option 1 Error
54 Std Par ENA Connection Lost
54 Par 1 ENA Connection Lost
54 Ser 1 Fax Connection Lost
54 Network 1 Software Error
55 Insufficient Fax Buffer
56 Serial Port 1 Disabled
56 Std Parallel Port Disabled
56 Parallel Port 1 Disabled
58 Too Many Flash Options
61 Defective Disk
62 Disk Full
63 Unformatted Disk
Print Jobs on Disk? Go/Stop?
If one of these errors occurs and Auto Continue is set to Disabled, the printer stops and waits
for operator intervention. When Auto Continue is set to a numerical value, the printer waits for
the specified length of time and then automatically resumes processing.
This setting is also used as a timer. After an inactive period in the menus, the printer automat-
ically exits the menus and returns to the Ready state.
Jam Recovery
On
Off
Auto*
When Jam Recovery is set to Off, the printer does not reprint a page that has jammed.
When Jam Recovery is set to On, the printer keeps the image for a printed page until the
printer signals that the page has successfully exited the printer. The printer reprints all
jammed pages.
If Jam Recovery is set to Auto, the printer keeps the image and reprints the page unless the
memory required to hold the page is needed for other printer tasks.
*Factory default
Operator Panel Menus
75
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Setup Menu (continued)
Menu Item
Values
Page Protect
Off*
On
Set Page Protect to On to make sure an entire page is processed before it is printed. This may
be helpful if you are having trouble printing a page properly because of complex page errors.
If you still cannot print the page, your printer may not have enough memory to process the
page. You may have to reduce the size and number of fonts on the page, or increase the
installed printer memory.
For most print jobs, you do not need to set Page Protect to On. When Page Protect is set to
On, printing may be slowed.
Print Area
Normal*
Whole Page
The Print Area setting lets you modify the PCL formatting area and the printer physical print
area. Refer to the Technical Reference for more information about printable areas.
Display Language
English*
French
German
Italian
Spanish
Danish
Norwegian
Dutch
Swedish
Portuguese
Finnish
The following languages appear as a menu item value on some operator panels:
Japanese
Russian
Polish
Hungarian
Turkish
Czech
The Display Language setting determines the language of the text that appears on the
operator panel display.
*Factory default
Chapter 3: Using the Operator Panel and Menus
76
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Setup Menu (continued)
Menu Item
Values
Alarm Control
Off
Single*
Continuous
If you want the printer alarm to sound any time the printer requires intervention, select Single
or Continuous. If you select Single, the printer sounds three quick beeps to let you know
operator intervention is required. If you select Continuous, the printer repeats the three beeps
every ten seconds.
Select Off if you do not want the alarm to sound.
Job Buffer Size
Disabled*
10…100%
If you have a hard disk option installed in your printer, you can allocate a portion of the
available hard disk space for processing print jobs. The job is temporarily stored on the hard
disk before being printed, usually freeing the host computer while the job prints.
The Job Buffer Size menu item lets you select the amount of hard disk space allocated to job
buffering for all ports that have Job Buffering set to On. You can choose any 1% increment
between 10% and 100%. You must select a Job Buffer Size before you can set the
Job Buffering menu item On in the PARALLEL MENU or USB MENU. See Job Buffering on
The Job Buffer Size menu item only displays if the installed hard disk option is formatted and
is not defective or Read/Write or Write protected. 61 Defective Disk may display when the
printer is turned on, or during disk format and write operations. See 61 Defective Disk on
page 165 for more information.
To password protect the hard disk option and use Job Buffering simultaneously, perform the
following steps in order:
•
•
•
Set the Job Buffer Size for the hard disk option.
Download the files you want to the hard disk option.
Password protect the disk.
Refer to the Technical Reference for detailed information on how to password protect the hard
disk option.
Warning: If you change the job buffer size, the printer formats the hard disk, and all resources
stored on the disk are deleted.
*Factory default
Operator Panel Menus
77
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Setup Menu (continued)
Menu Item
Values
Job Accounting
Off*
On
If Job Accounting is set to On, the installed hard disk option stores statistical information
about the most recent printer jobs. The statistics include whether the job printed with or
without errors, the time required to print the job, the size (in bytes) of the job, the requested
paper size and paper type, the total number of printed pages, and the number of copies
requested.
To print a listing of all the accumulated statistics, select Print from the Job Acct Stat menu
The Job Accounting menu item does not display if the installed disk option is defective or
Read/Write or Write protected, or if Job Buffer Size is set to 100%. See Job Buffer Size on
page 77 for more information.
Job Acct Limit
Disabled
10…1000* (in increments of 1 job)
If a hard disk option is installed in your printer, you can use the hard disk to store statistical
information about a specified number of jobs. The value you select from the Job Acct Limit
menu item determines the number of jobs for which statistics are stored. Once you reach the
job limit, statistics for the oldest job are deleted as new statistics are stored, maintaining
statistics for the specified number of jobs.
If you select Disabled, the number of jobs for which statistics are stored is limited to the
memory available on the hard disk.
The Job Acct Limit menu item does not display if the installed hard disk option is defective or
Read/Write or Write protected, or if Job Buffer Size is set to 100%. See Job Buffer Size on
page 77 for more information.
Warning: When you change the Job Acct Limit value, all statistical information stored on the
disk option is discarded.
*Factory default
Chapter 3: Using the Operator Panel and Menus
78
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
PCL Emul Menu
Use the PCL EMUL MENU to change printer settings that
only affect jobs printed using the PCL emulation printer
language.
PCL Emul Menu
Menu Item
Values
Font Source
Resident*
Download
Flash
Disk
All
The Font Source setting determines which fonts appear in the Font Name menu.
If a font source is not installed or does not contain any fonts, it is not listed as a value. Fonts
are loaded and stored on the flash memory option.
Font Name
Font position and font name for all fonts in the selected font source (displays on both lines of
the operator panel)
(R0 Courier*)
After you select a font source, choose the specific font from the Font Name menu item. The
printer displays the font source abbreviation, font ID, and font name for each font. The font
source abbreviation is R for resident, F for flash, K for disk, and D for download.
Note: Always select the correct Font Source before you select the Font Name.
Point Size
1…1008 (in increments of 0.25)
(only displays for
PostScript or
(12*)
typographic fonts)
Point size refers to the height of the characters in the font. One point equals approximately
1/72 of an inch.
If you chose a scalable typographic font, you can select the point size for the font. You can
page 232 for more information.
*Factory default
Operator Panel Menus
79
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
PCL Emul Menu (continued)
Menu Item
Values
Pitch
0.08…100 (in increments of 0.01)
(only displays for
fixed or
(10*)
monospaced fonts)
Pitch refers to the number of fixed-space characters in a horizontal inch of type.
If you chose a scalable monospaced font, you can select the font pitch. You can select a pitch
from 0.08 to 100 characters per inch (cpi) in increments of 0.01 cpi. For non-scalable
page 232 for more information.
Symbol Set
List of Symbol Set IDs and Symbol Set names (displays on both lines of the operator panel)
10U PC-8* (Country specific)
12U PC-850* (Country specific)
A symbol set is a set of alphabetic and numeric characters, punctuation, and special symbols
used when printing with a selected font. Symbol sets support the different requirements for
languages or specific applications, such as math symbols for scientific text. The printer
displays only the symbol sets supported for the selected font name.
Orientation
Portrait*
Landscape
The Orientation setting determines how the printing is oriented on the page.
Select Portrait to print parallel to the short edge of the print material.
This is
PORTRAIT
orientation.
This is
PORTRAIT
orientation.
This is
Select Landscape to print parallel to the long edge of the print material.
This is
LANDSCAPE
orientation. This
is LANDSCAPE
orientation.
*Factory default
Chapter 3: Using the Operator Panel and Menus
80
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
PCL Emul Menu (continued)
Menu Item
Values
Lines per Page
1…255
60* (Country specific)
64* (Country specific)
Use the Lines per Page menu item to change the number of lines that print on each page.
The Lines per Page setting can range from 1 to 255 lines per page. The printer sets the
amount of space between each line (vertical line spacing) based on the Lines per Page,
PAPER SIZE, and Orientation settings. Select the correct PAPER SIZE from the PAPER MENU
A4 Width
198 mm*
203 mm
The A4 Width menu item lets you select the width of the logical page for A4 paper.
When you select 198 mm, the width of the logical page is compatible with that of the
Hewlett-Packard LaserJet 5 printer. When you select 203 mm, the width of the logical page is
wide enough to print eighty 10-pitch characters.
*Factory default
Operator Panel Menus
81
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
PCL Emul Menu (continued)
Menu Item
Values
TRAY RENUMBER Assign MP Feeder
Assign Tray 1
Assign Tray 2
Assign Man Paper
Assign Man Env
Each of the above menu items supports the following three values:
Off*
0 ... 199
None
VIEW FACTORY DEF
Restore Defaults
Yes
No
Note: Assign Tray 2 only displays if the optional 500-sheet drawer is installed.
Assign MP Feeder only displays when Configure MP is set to Cassette.
Only installed paper sources display on the operator panel as values. However, you may set
TRAY RENUMBER to uninstalled sources.
The TRAY RENUMBER menu item lets you configure your printer to work with printer drivers
or applications that use different source assignments to request a given input source.
Select Off to use the factory default paper source assignments.
Select a numeric value (0 ... 199) to assign a custom value to a paper source.
Select VIEW FACTORY DEF to view the factory default values assigned to each paper source.
In the Restore Defaults menu item, select Yes to return all tray assignments to factory default
values.
your printer.
Refer to the Technical Reference for more information about assigning source numbers.
Auto CR after LF
Auto LF after CR
*Factory default
Off*
On
The Auto CR after LF setting determines if the printer automatically performs a carriage return
after a line feed control command.
Off*
On
The Auto LF after CR setting determines if the printer automatically performs a line feed after
a carriage return control command.
Chapter 3: Using the Operator Panel and Menus
82
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
PostScript Menu
Use the POSTSCRIPT MENU to change settings that only
affect jobs printed using the PostScript 3 emulation printer
language.
PostScript Menu
Menu Item
Values
Print PS Error
Off*
On
Select On to print PostScript 3 emulation errors. If an error occurs, the job stops processing,
the error message prints, and the printer discards the job.
If Print PS Error is set to Off and an error occurs, the job is discarded but no error message
prints.
Font Priority
Resident*
Flash / Disk
The Font Priority menu item only displays if a flash memory or disk option is installed,
formatted and is not defective, Read/Write or Write protected and Job Buffer Size is not set to
*Factory default
Operator Panel Menus
83
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Parallel Menu
Use the PARALLEL MENU to change settings affecting
jobs sent to the printer through the parallel interface con-
nection. PARALLEL MENU displays as a standard feature
or as an option, and appears as one of the following:
•
•
STD PARALLEL
PARALLEL OPT 1
PARALLEL OPT 1 is only available if a parallel/ USB
interface option card is installed. The following menu
items set the configuration of the parallel interface connec-
tion.
Parallel Menu
Menu Item
Values
PCL SmartSwitch
Off
On*
If PCL SmartSwitch is set to On, the printer examines the data on the parallel interface
connection and selects PCL emulation if the data indicates that is the printer language.
If both PCL SmartSwitch and PS SmartSwitch are set to Off, the printer uses the language
specified in the Printer Language menu as the default. If only one SmartSwitch setting is set
to Off, the printer uses the language that has its SmartSwitch setting set to On as the default.
PS SmartSwitch
Off
On*
If PS SmartSwitch is set to On, the printer examines the data on the parallel interface
connection and selects PostScript 3 emulation if the data indicates that is the printer
language.
If both PCL SmartSwitch and PS SmartSwitch are set to Off, the printer uses the language
specified in the Printer Language menu as the default. If only one SmartSwitch setting is set
to Off, the printer uses the language that has its SmartSwitch setting set to On as the default.
*Factory default
Chapter 3: Using the Operator Panel and Menus
84
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Parallel Menu (continued)
Menu Item
Values
NPA Mode
On
Off
Auto*
NPA is a mode of bidirectional communication that follows the conventions defined in Network
Printing Alliance Protocol, A Printer/Host Control Specification Developed by the NPA. NPA
mode requires special processing of the print data.
If NPA Mode is set to On, the data received must be in NPA format. If not, it is rejected as bad
data. If NPA Mode is set to Off, the printer does not perform any NPA processing. If NPA Mode
is set to Auto, the printer examines the data to determine the format and then processes it in
either format.
The NPA Mode setting in the PARALLEL MENU applies only to the parallel interface
connection.
Note: Changing the NPA Mode setting automatically resets the printer.
Parallel Buffer
Disabled
Auto*
3K to maximum size allowed
You can configure the size of the parallel input buffer to meet the requirements of your system.
The maximum size available for modification depends on the amount of memory in your
printer, the size of the other link buffers, and whether Resource Save is set to On or Off. To
maximize the range for the parallel buffer size, you can disable or reduce the size of the serial,
network, infrared, LocalTalk, and Universal Serial Bus (USB) buffers.
Choose Auto to let the printer calculate a buffer size proportional to the total amount of
available printer memory. In most cases, Auto is the recommended setting.
Note: Changing the Parallel Buffer setting automatically resets the printer.
Job Buffering
Off*
On
Job buffering lets you delay processing of a print job. The job is temporarily stored on a hard
disk option before being printed, usually freeing the host computer while the job prints.
The Job Buffering menu item only displays if the installed hard disk option is formatted and is
not defective, Read/Write or Write protected, and if Job Buffer Size is not set to Disabled. See
printer is turned on, or during disk format and write operations. See 61 Defective Disk on
page 165 for more information.
If Job Buffering is set to On, print jobs are buffered to the hard disk option. If Job Buffering is
set to Off, print jobs are not buffered.
Note: Changing the Job Buffering setting automatically resets the printer.
*Factory default
Operator Panel Menus
85
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Parallel Menu (continued)
Menu Item
Values
Advanced Status
Off
On*
If Advanced Status is set to On, bidirectional communication is enabled through the parallel
interface.
Protocol
Standard
Fastbytes*
You can select Standard or Fastbytes protocol for the parallel interface. Fastbytes is
compatible with most existing parallel interface implementations. Use Standard only if you
experience parallel interface problems.
Refer to the Technical Reference for more information about the parallel interface.
Honor Init
Off*
On
The Honor Init setting determines whether the printer honors hardware initialization requests
from the computer. The computer requests initialization by activating the INIT signal on the
parallel interface. Many personal computers activate the INIT signal each time the computer is
turned on and off.
Parallel Mode 1
Off
On*
The Parallel Mode 1 setting controls the pull up resistors on the parallel port signals. It is
useful for personal computers that have open collector outputs on the parallel port signals.
Set Parallel Mode 1 to On to disable the resistors or to Off to enable the resistors.
Note: This menu item is not available on the Optra M412.
Parallel Mode 2
Off
On*
The Parallel Mode 2 setting determines if the parallel port data is sampled on the leading or
trailing edge of strobe.
If Parallel Mode 2 is set to On, the parallel port data is sampled on the leading edge of strobe.
If Parallel Mode 2 is set to Off, the parallel port data is sampled on the trailing edge of strobe.
*Factory default
Chapter 3: Using the Operator Panel and Menus
86
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Serial Menu
Use the SERIAL MENU to change settings affecting jobs
sent to the printer through the serial interface port.
SERIAL MENU displays as an option, and appears as
SERIAL OPTION 1. SERIAL OPTION 1 is only available if
the Tri-Port interface option card is installed and Fax Port
is set to disabled.
Serial Menu
Menu Item
Values
PCL SmartSwitch
Off
On*
If PCL SmartSwitch is set to On, the printer examines the data on the serial interface
connection and selects PCL emulation if the data indicates that is the printer language.
If both PCL SmartSwitch and PS SmartSwitch are set to Off, the printer uses the language
specified in the Printer Language menu as the default. If only one SmartSwitch setting is set
to Off, the printer uses the language that has its SmartSwitch setting set to On as the default.
PS SmartSwitch
Off
On*
If PS SmartSwitch is set to On, the printer examines the data on the serial interface
connection and selects PostScript 3 emulation if the data indicates that is the printer
language.
If both PCL Smartswitch and PS Smartswitch are set to Off, the printer uses the language
specified in the Printer Language menu as the default. If only one SmartSwitch setting is set
to Off, the printer uses the language that has its SmartSwitch setting set to On as the default.
NPA Mode
On
Off
Auto*
NPA is a mode of bidirectional communication that follows the conventions defined in Network
Printing Alliance Protocol, A Printer/Host Control Specification Developed by the NPA. NPA
mode requires special processing of the print data.
If NPA Mode is set to On, the data received must be in NPA format. If not, it is rejected as bad
data. If NPA Mode is set to Off, the printer does not perform any NPA processing. If NPA Mode
is set to Auto, the printer examines the data to determine the format and then processes it in
either format.
The NPA Mode setting in the SERIAL MENU applies only to the serial interface connection.
Note: Changing the NPA Mode setting automatically resets the printer.
*Factory default
Operator Panel Menus
87
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Serial Menu (continued)
Menu Item
Values
Serial Buffer
Disabled
Auto*
3K to maximum size allowed
You can configure the size of the serial input buffer to meet the requirements of your system.
If the limited size of the serial buffer is preventing you from continuing work in your software
application each time you send a job to the printer, you may want to increase the buffer size.
The maximum size depends on the amount of memory in your printer, the size of the other link
buffers and whether the Resource Save setting is set to On or Off. To maximize the range for
the serial buffer size, you can disable or reduce the size of the parallel, infrared, LocalTalk,
and USB buffers. Choose Auto to let the printer calculate a buffer size proportional to the total
amount of available printer memory. In most cases, Auto is the recommended setting.
Note: Changing the Serial Buffer setting automatically resets the printer.
RS-232/RS-422
RS-422 Polarity
RS-232*
RS-422
Choose the serial communication configuration for your printer. Selecting RS-422 automat-
ically sets Serial Protocol to XON/XOFF.
Normal*
Reverse
Select Normal or Reverse polarity.
This setting is only available if the serial communication configuration is set to RS-422. To do
this, select SERIAL MENU, SERIAL OPTION 1, RS-232/RS-422, and RS-422.
Serial Protocol
DTR* (hardware handshaking)
DTR/DSR (hardware handshaking)
XON/XOFF (software handshaking)
XON/XOFF/DTR (combined handshaking)
XON/XOFF/DTR/DSR (combined handshaking)
Handshaking is the exchange of predetermined signals when a connection is established.
This printer supports hardware handshaking, software handshaking, and combined hardware
and software handshaking.
Refer to the Technical Reference for more information about serial interface.
Robust XON
Off*
On
Robust XON only applies to the serial port if Serial Protocol is set to XON/XOFF.
When Robust XON is set to On, the printer sends a continuous stream of XONs to the host
computer to indicate that the serial port is ready to receive more data.
*Factory default
Chapter 3: Using the Operator Panel and Menus
88
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Serial Menu (continued)
Menu Item
Values
Baud
1200
2400
4800
9600*
19200
38400
57600
115200
This setting lets you select the rate at which data is being sent to or from your computer. Refer
to the Technical Reference for information about the range of baud values.
Data Bits
7
8*
This setting lets you select the number of data bits that are sent in each transmission frame.
Refer to the Technical Reference for more information about data bits.
*Factory default
Operator Panel Menus
89
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Serial Menu (continued)
Menu Item
Values
Parity
Even
Odd
None*
Ignore
This setting lets you select the parity for serial input and output data frames.
Even The port expects to receive data frames with an even number of logical 1’s per
byte. The port transmits XOFF and XON with even parity. If the port detects a
parity error, the port sends an inverted question mark to the printer instead of the
character sent by the host system.
Odd
The port expects to receive data frames with an odd number of logical 1’s per
byte. The printer transmits XOFF and XON with odd parity. If the printer detects a
parity error, the port sends X'5F' to the printer instead of the character sent by the
host system.
None The port expects no parity bit when it receives data. The port transmits XON and
XOFF without parity bits.
Ignore The port expects a parity bit when the port receives a data frame. The port
ignores the parity bit. The port uses even parity when it transmits XON and XOFF.
Refer to the Technical Reference for more information about parity.
Honor DSR
(only available if
configured for
RS-232)
Off*
On
Honor DSR determines if the printer uses the Data Set Ready (DSR) signal. DSR is one of the
handshaking signals for most serial interface cables. If Honor DSR is set to Off, data received
by the serial interface is seen as valid data. If Honor DSR is set to On, only data received
while the DSR signal is in high condition is treated as valid data.
The serial interface uses DSR to distinguish data sent by the computer from data created by
electrical noise in the serial cable. This electrical noise can cause stray characters to print.
Set Honor DSR to On to prevent stray characters from printing.
*Factory default
Chapter 3: Using the Operator Panel and Menus
90
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Network Menu
Use the NETWORK MENU to change settings affecting
jobs sent to the printer through the network port.
NETWORK MENU displays as an option, and appears as
NETWORK OPTION 1. NETWORK OPTION 1 is only
available if an optional print server is installed in your
printer.
Network Menu
Menu Item
Values
PCL SmartSwitch
Off
On*
If PCL SmartSwitch is set to On, the printer examines the data on the network interface
connection and selects PCL emulation if the data indicates that is the printer language.
If both PCL SmartSwitch and PS SmartSwitch are set to Off, the printer uses the language
specified in the Printer Language menu as the default. If only one SmartSwitch setting is set
to Off, the printer uses the language that has its SmartSwitch set to On as the default.
PS SmartSwitch
Off
On*
If PS SmartSwitch is set to On the printer examines the data on the network interface
connection and selects PostScript 3 emulation if the data indicates that is the printer
language.
If both PCL SmartSwitch and PS SmartSwitch are set to Off, the printer uses the language
specified in the Printer Language menu as the default. If only one SmartSwitch setting is set
to Off, the printer uses the language that has its SmartSwitch setting set to On as the default.
NPA Mode
Off
Auto*
NPA is a mode of bidirectional communication that follows the conventions defined in Network
Printing Alliance Protocol, A Printer/Host Control Specification Developed by the NPA. NPA
mode requires special processing of the print data.
If NPA Mode is set to On, the data received must be in NPA format. If not, it is rejected as bad
data. If NPA Mode is set to Off, the printer does not perform any NPA processing. If NPA Mode
is set to Auto, the printer examines the data to determine the format and then processes it in
either format.
The NPA Mode setting in the NETWORK MENU applies only to the network interface
connection.
Note: Changing the NPA Mode setting automatically resets the printer.
*Factory default
Operator Panel Menus
91
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Network Menu (continued)
Menu Item
Values
Network Buffer
Auto*
3K to maximum size allowed
You can configure the size of the network input buffer to meet the requirements of your
system. If the limited size of the network buffer is preventing you from continuing work in your
software application each time you send a job to the printer, you may want to increase the
buffer size.
The maximum size available for modification depends on the amount of memory in your
printer, the size of the other link buffers, and whether Resource Save is set to On or Off. To
maximize the range for the network buffer size, you can disable or reduce the size of the
parallel and USB buffers.
Choose Auto to let the printer calculate the buffer size proportional to the total amount of
available printer memory. In most cases, Auto is the recommended setting.
Note: Changing the Network Buffer setting automatically resets the printer.
Network 1 Setup
*Factory default
Values for this menu item are supplied by the specific network card. Open the menu to see the
available values.
For more information, refer to the documentation that comes with your network option.
Chapter 3: Using the Operator Panel and Menus
92
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Infrared Menu
Use the INFRARED MENU to change settings affecting
jobs sent to the printer through the infrared interface port.
If Infrared Port is set to Disabled, all other menu items in the
INFRARED MENU are not available.
This menu is only available if the Tri-Port interface option
card is installed in your printer.
Infrared Menu
Menu Item
Values
Infrared Port
Disabled*
IR Option 1
Select IR Option 1 to activate the infrared port on the Tri-Port interface option card.
If you select Disabled, all of the other menu items in the INFRARED MENU are not available.
PCL SmartSwitch
Off
On*
If PCL SmartSwitch is set to On, the printer examines the data on the infrared interface
connection and selects PCL emulation if the data indicates that is the printer language.
If both PCL SmartSwitch and PS SmartSwitch are set to Off, the printer uses the language
specified in the Printer Language menu as the default. If only one SmartSwitch setting is set
to Off, the printer uses the language that has its SmartSwitch setting set to On as the default.
PS SmartSwitch
Off
On*
If PS SmartSwitch is set to On the printer examines the data on the network infrared
connection and selects PostScript 3 emulation if the data indicates that is the printer
language.
If both PCL SmartSwitch and PS SmartSwitch are set to Off, the printer uses the language
specified in the Printer Language menu as the default. If only one SmartSwitch setting is set
to Off, the printer uses the language that has its SmartSwitch setting set to On as the default.
*Factory default
Operator Panel Menus
93
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Infrared Menu (continued)
Menu Item
Values
NPA Mode
Off
Auto*
NPA is a mode of bidirectional communication that follows the conventions defined in Network
Printing Alliance Protocol, A Printer/Host Control Specification Developed by the NPA. NPA
mode requires special processing of the print data.
If NPA Mode is set to On, the data received must be in NPA format. If not, it is rejected as bad
data. If NPA Mode is set to Off, the printer does not perform any NPA processing. If NPA Mode
is set to Auto, the printer examines the data to determine the format and then processes it in
either format.
The NPA Mode setting in the INFRARED MENU applies only to the infrared interface
connection.
Note: Changing the NPA Mode setting automatically resets the printer.
Infrared Buffer
Disabled
Auto*
5K to maximum size allowed
You can configure the size of the infrared input buffer to meet the requirements of your
system. If the limited size of the input buffer is preventing you from continuing work in your
software application each time you send a job to the printer, you may want to increase the
buffer size.
The maximum size available for modification depends on the amount of memory in your
printer, the size of the other link buffers, and whether Resource Save is set to On or Off. To
maximize the range for the infrared buffer size, you can disable or reduce the size of the
parallel, serial, LocalTalk, and USB buffers.
Choose Auto to let the printer calculate a buffer size proportional to the total amount of
available printer memory. In most cases, Auto is the recommended setting.
Note: Changing the Infrared Buffer setting automatically resets the printer.
Window Size
Auto*
1
The Window Size setting specifies the maximum number of infrared frames the printer can
receive before it must send an acknowledgment to the host computer.
Select Auto to let the printer automatically set the window size during a power on reset to
maximize link performance.
In most cases, Auto is the recommended setting. If you have trouble printing using the
infrared port, changing the Window Size setting to 1 may resolve the problem.
*Factory default
Chapter 3: Using the Operator Panel and Menus
94
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Infrared Menu (continued)
Menu Item
Values
Transmit Delay
Auto*
None
1…15
The Transmit Delay setting defines the amount of time the printer must wait before trans-
mitting meaningful infrared data to the host computer, as well as the amount of time the
printer requests the host computer to wait before it transmits infrared data.
Select Auto to let the printer automatically set the Transmit Delay value during a power on
reset to maximize link performance.
In most cases, Auto is the recommended setting. If you have trouble printing using the
infrared port, selecting a high Transmit Delay setting, such as 15, may resolve the problem.
Max Baud Rate
2400
9600
19200
38400
57600
115200
576000
1152000*
4000000
The maximum baud rate possible for both the printer and the infrared adapter is automatically
set during a power on reset. However, if your printer is situated in a bright or highly reflective
environment, you may experience intermittent communication problems. If you do, select a
lower baud rate for the infrared connection.
*Factory default
Operator Panel Menus
95
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
LocalTalk Menu
Use the LOCALTALK MENU to change settings affecting
jobs sent to the printer through the LocalTalk port.
If LocalTalk Port is set to Disabled, all other menu items in
the LOCALTALK MENU are not available.
This menu is only available if the Tri-Port interface option
card is installed in your printer.
LocalTalk Menu
Menu Item
Values
LocalTalk Port
Disabled*
LTalk Option 1
Select LTalk Option 1 to activate the LocalTalk port on the Tri-Port interface option card.
If you select Disabled, all of the other menu items in the LOCALTALK MENU are not available.
PCL SmartSwitch
Off
On*
If PCL SmartSwitch is set to On, the printer examines the data on the LocalTalk interface
connection and selects PCL emulation if the data indicates that is the printer language.
If both PCL SmartSwitch and PS SmartSwitch are set to Off, the printer uses the language
specified in the Printer Language menu as the default. If only one SmartSwitch setting is set
to Off, the printer uses the language that has its SmartSwitch setting set to On as the default.
PS SmartSwitch
Off
On*
If PS SmartSwitch is set to On, the printer examines the data on the specified LocalTalk
interface connection and selects PostScript 3 emulation if the data indicates that is the printer
language.
If both PCL SmartSwitch and PS SmartSwitch are set to Off, the printer uses the language
specified in the Printer Language menu as the default. If only one SmartSwitch setting is set
to Off, the printer uses the language that has its SmartSwitch setting set to On as the default.
*Factory default
Chapter 3: Using the Operator Panel and Menus
96
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
LocalTalk Menu (continued)
Menu Item
Values
NPA Mode
Off
Auto*
NPA is a mode of bidirectional communication that follows the conventions defined in Network
Printing Alliance Protocol, A Printer/Host Control Specification Developed by the NPA. NPA
mode requires special processing of the print data.
If NPA Mode is set to On, the data received must be in NPA format. If not, it is rejected as bad
data. If NPA Mode is set to Off, the printer does not perform any NPA processing. If NPA Mode
is set to Auto, the printer examines the data to determine the format and then processes it in
either format.
The NPA Mode setting in the LOCALTALK MENU applies only to the LocalTalk interface
connection.
Note: Changing the NPA Mode setting automatically resets the printer.
LocalTalk Buffer
Disabled
Auto*
6K to maximum size allowed
You can configure the size of the LocalTalk input buffer to meet the requirements of your
system. If the limited size of the input buffer is preventing you from continuing work in your
software application each time you send a job to the printer, you may want to increase the
buffer size.
The maximum size available for modification depends on the amount of memory in your
printer, the size of the other link buffers, and whether Resource Save is set to On or Off. To
maximize the range for the LocalTalk buffer size, you can disable or reduce the size of the
parallel, serial, infrared, and USB buffers.
Choose Auto to let the printer calculate a buffer size proportional to the total amount of
available printer memory. In most cases, Auto is the recommended setting.
Note: Changing the LocalTalk Buffer setting automatically resets the printer.
NPA Hosts
1…10 (2*)
Use this setting to specify the maximum number of NPA hosts that can register for NPA printer
alerts. When the number of hosts registered for NPA alerts exceeds the quantity specified by
NPA Hosts, any additional hosts attempting to register for alerts are ignored.
Note: Changing the NPA Hosts setting automatically resets the printer.
LocalTalk Name
*Factory default
Lexmark Optra M410 or Lexmark Optra M412
This setting identifies the printer model name stored in printer memory. It cannot be modified
through the operator panel.
Operator Panel Menus
97
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
LocalTalk Menu (continued)
Menu Item
Values
LocalTalk Addr
(LocalTalk Node Number)
This setting identifies the LocalTalk Node number assigned to the printer. It cannot be
modified through the operator panel.
LocalTalk Zone
*Factory default
(Zone name provided by LocalTalk network)
This setting determines the LocalTalk Zone. It cannot be modified through the operator panel.
Chapter 3: Using the Operator Panel and Menus
98
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
USB Menu
Use the USB MENU to change settings affecting the Uni-
versal Serial Bus (USB) interface port. The USB MENU
displays as a standard feature or as an option, and appears
as one of the following:
•
•
STANDARD USB
USB OPTION 1
USB OPTION 1 is only available if a parallel/ USB inter-
face option card is installed on the printer system board.
USB Menu
Menu Item
Values
PCL SmartSwitch
Off
On*
If PCL SmartSwitch is set to On, the printer examines the data on the USB interface
connection and selects PCL emulation if the data indicates that is the printer language.
If both PCL SmartSwitch and PS SmartSwitch are set to Off, the printer uses the language
specified in the Printer Language menu as the default. If only one SmartSwitch setting is
set to Off, the printer uses the language that has its SmartSwitch setting set to On as the
default.
PS SmartSwitch
Off
On*
If PS SmartSwitch is set to On, the printer examines the data on the specified USB
interface connection and selects PostScript 3 emulation if the data indicates that is the
printer language.
If both PCL SmartSwitch and PS SmartSwitch are set to Off, the printer uses the language
specified in the Printer Language menu as the default. If only one SmartSwitch setting is
set to Off, the printer uses the language that has its SmartSwitch setting set to On as the
default.
*Factory default
Operator Panel Menus
99
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
USB Menu (continued)
Menu Item
Values
NPA Mode
On
Off
Auto*
NPA is a mode of bidirectional communication that follows the conventions defined in
Network Printing Alliance Protocol, A Printer/Host Control Specification Developed by the
NPA. NPA mode requires special processing of the print data.
If NPA Mode is set to On, the data received must be in NPA format. If not, it is rejected as
bad data. If NPA Mode is set to Off, the printer does not perform any NPA processing. If
NPA Mode is set to Auto, the printer examines the data to determine the format and then
processes it in either format.
The NPA Mode setting in the USB MENU applies only to the USB interface connection.
Note: Changing the NPA Mode setting automatically resets the printer.
USB Buffer
Disabled
Auto*
3K to maximum size allowed
You can configure the size of the USB input buffer to meet the requirements of your
system. If the limited size of the input buffer is preventing you from continuing work in your
software application each time you send a job to the printer, you may want to increase the
buffer size.
The maximum size available for modification depends on the amount of memory in your
printer, the size of the other link buffers, and whether Resource Save is set to On or Off. To
maximize the range for the USB buffer size, you can disable or reduce the size of the
parallel, serial, network, infrared, and LocalTalk buffers.
Choose Auto to let the printer calculate a buffer size proportional to the total amount of
available printer memory. In most cases, Auto is the recommended setting.
Note: Changing the USB Buffer setting automatically resets the printer.
*Factory default
Chapter 3: Using the Operator Panel and Menus
100
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
USB Menu (continued)
Menu Item
Values
Job Buffering
Off*
On
This menu item only displays if you are using standard USB and have a hard disk option
card installed.
Job buffering lets you delay processing of a print job. The job is temporarily stored on a
hard disk option before being printed, usually freeing the host computer while the job
prints.
The Job Buffering menu item only displays if the installed hard disk option is formatted and
is not defective, Read/Write or Write protected, and if Job Buffer Size is not set to
display when the printer is turned on, or during disk format and write operations. See
If Job Buffering is set to On, print jobs are buffered to the hard disk option. If Job Buffering
is set to Off, print jobs are not buffered.
Note: Changing the Job Buffering setting automatically resets the printer.
*Factory default
Operator Panel Menus
101
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Fax Menu
Use the FAX MENU to change settings affecting fax data
received by the printer through the serial interface port on
the Tri-Port interface option card.
With the Tri-Port interface option card installed, the
printer can receive and print fax data.
If Fax Port is set to Disabled, all other menu items in the
FAX MENU are not available.
Ser Option 1 is only available if a Tri-Port interface option
information.
Fax Menu
Menu Item
Values
Fax Port
Disabled*
Ser Option 1
Select Ser Option 1 to activate the serial port on the Tri-Port interface option card and
configure it to receive fax data.
If you select Disabled, all of the other menu items in the FAX MENU are not available.
Fax Baud
1200
2400
4800
9600
19200*
38400
57600
115200
This setting lets you select the rate at which fax data is being sent to or from your computer.
Refer to the Technical Reference for information about the range of baud values.
Fax Data Bits
7
8*
This setting lets you select the number of fax data bits that are sent in each transmission
frame. Refer to the Technical Reference for more information about data bits.
*Factory default
Chapter 3: Using the Operator Panel and Menus
102
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Fax Menu (continued)
Menu Item
Values
Fax Parity
Even
Odd
None*
Ignore
The Fax Parity setting lets you select the parity for fax data frames.
Even The port expects to receive data frames with an even number of logical 1’s per
byte. The port transmits XOFF and XON with even parity. If the port detects a
parity error, it sends an inverted question mark to the printer instead of the
character sent by the host system.
Odd
The port expects to receive data frames with an odd number of logical 1’s per byte.
The printer transmits XOFF and XON with odd parity. If the printer detects a parity
error, it sends X'5F' to the printer instead of the character sent by the host system.
None The port expects no parity bit when it receives data. The port transmits XON and
XOFF without parity bits.
Ignore The port expects a parity bit when it receives a data frame. The port ignores the
parity bit and uses even parity when it transmits XON and XOFF.
Refer to the Technical Reference for more information about parity.
Fax Buffer
Disabled
Auto*
105K to max size allowed
You can configure the size of the fax input buffer to meet the requirements of your system. If
the limited size of the input buffer is preventing you from receiving fax data, you may want to
increase the fax buffer size.
The maximum size depends on the amount of memory in your printer, the size of the other link
buffers and whether the Resource Save setting is set to On or Off. To maximize the range for
the fax buffer size, you can disable or reduce the size of the parallel, infrared, LocalTalk, and
USB buffers.
Choose Auto to let the printer calculate a buffer size proportional to the total amount of
available printer memory. In most cases, Auto is the recommended setting.
Note: Changing the Fax Buffer setting automatically resets the printer.
*Factory default
Operator Panel Menus
103
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Fax Menu (continued)
Menu Item
Values
Fax Paper Size
A4* (Country specific)
A5
JIS B5
Letter* (Country specific)
Legal
Executive
Universal
The Fax Paper Size setting lets you specify the size of print material used for printing fax data.
Incoming faxes are automatically formatted to print on the paper size set in the Fax Paper Size
menu item.
The printer automatically prints from the paper source containing the correct paper size and
paper type as specified in the Fax Paper Size and Fax Paper Type settings. If no paper source
contains the correct paper size and paper type, you are prompted to change the print material
in a selected source to match the Fax Paper Size and Fax Paper Type settings. See Fax Paper
*Factory default
Chapter 3: Using the Operator Panel and Menus
104
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Fax Menu (continued)
Menu Item
Values
Fax Paper Type
Plain Paper*
Card Stock
Transparency
Labels
Bond
Letterhead
Preprinted
Colored Paper
Custom Type 1
Custom Type 2
Custom Type 3
Custom Type 4
Custom Type 5
Custom Type 6
The Fax Paper Type setting lets you specify the type of print material used for printing fax data.
The printer automatically prints from the paper source containing the correct paper size and
paper type as specified in the Fax Paper Size and Fax Paper Type settings. If no paper source
contains the correct paper size and paper type, you are prompted to change the print material
in a selected source to match the Fax Paper Size and Fax Paper Type settings. See Fax Paper
Custom Type 1 through 6 refers to special types of print materials. You can change the names
through a utility, such as MarkVision. The user-defined name is truncated to 14 characters. For
*Factory default
Operator Panel Menus
105
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Config Menu
You only have access to the CONFIG MENU if you follow
these steps:
1 Turn the printer power Off (O).
2 Press and hold the Select and Return buttons and
turn the printer power On (| ).
3 Release the buttons when Performing Self Test
appears on the operator panel display.
When the printer self test completes, the CONFIG
MENU displays.
When you exit the CONFIG MENU, the printer restarts
automatically and returns to the Ready state. See
Config Menu
Menu Item
Values
Prt Quality Pgs
Press Select to print the quality test pages. The first page contains a combination of graphics
and text which always prints in English. The second and third pages contain graphics only.
Note: PAPER SIZE must be set to Letter, Legal, or A-4 to print quality test pages. See PAPER
Panel Menus
Buffered Jobs
Disable
Enable*
Discard
Select Discard to delete all print jobs stored in the print buffer.
The message Formatting Disk briefly appears while the buffered jobs are being discarded.
*Factory default
Chapter 3: Using the Operator Panel and Menus
106
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Config Menu (continued)
Menu Item
Values
Factory Defaults
Restore All
If you select Restore All:
•
All downloaded resources (fonts, macros, symbol sets) in printer memory (RAM) are
deleted. (Resources residing in flash memory or on the hard disk option are unaffected.)
All menu settings are returned to the factory default values except:
•
– Display Language (SETUP MENU) which is the operator panel display language.
– All settings in the PARALLEL MENU, SERIAL MENU, NETWORK MENU, INFRARED
MENU, LOCALTALK MENU, USB MENU, and FAX MENU.
The message Restoring Factory Defaults briefly appears while the printer restores the factory
NARROW MEDIA
Plain Width
Card Stock Width
Trnsprncy Width
Labels Width
Bond Width
Letterhead Width
Preprinted Width
Colored Width
Envelope Width
Custom 1 Width
Custom 2 Width
Custom 3 Width
Custom 4 Width
Custom 5 Width
Custom 6 Width
Each of the above menu items support the following values as a second menu:
Normal*
Narrow
Set NARROW MEDIA to Narrow when using print material less than 172 mm (6.77 in.) in width,
so the printer can adjust its speed, thus prolonging the life of the fuser.
Custom x Width refers to special types of print materials. You can change the names through a
utility, such as MarkVision. If a user-defined name is available, the name displays instead of
Custom x Width, where x represents a number 1 through 6. The user-defined name is
truncated to 16 characters.
Exit Config Menu
*Factory default
Press Select to exit the CONFIG MENU. The printer automatically restarts and returns to the
Ready state.
Operator Panel Menus
107
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Understanding The Print and Hold function lets you delay the printing of
a job, print it later, and ask for additional copies.
Print and
Hold Jobs
The types of Print and Hold jobs are:
Note: The Print and Hold func-
tion requires a total of 8MB or
more of memory. We recom-
mend installing 16MB or more of
memory and a hard disk option.
•
•
•
•
Confidential Job
Repeat Print Job
Reserve Print Job
Verify Print Job
In the JOB MENU, there are two categories or menu items
of Print and Hold jobs:
•
•
CONFIDENTIAL JOB
HELD JOBS
Repeat Print job, Reserve Print job, and Verify Print job are
grouped into the category called Held Jobs.
You select the type of job you want from your software
application or printer driver. To access your jobs once they
are sent to print, you must use the operator panel or the
remote operator panel in MarkVision to enter the JOB
MENU.
Confidential Jobs
When you send a Confidential Job, the printer formats
your job and holds the job in memory. The printer delays
the printing of your job until you enter a PIN assigned to
the job. You enter the number through the operator panel.
For more information about Confidential Jobs, see
CONFIDENTIAL JOB on page 60.
•
•
•
To print a specific Confidential Job, see PRINT A JOB
To print additional copies of a Confidential Job, see
PRINT COPIES on page 64.
Chapter 3: Using the Operator Panel and Menus
108
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
•
•
To delete a specific Confidential Job, see
DELETE A JOB on page 63.
Held Jobs
Held Jobs refers any of the following types of jobs: Repeat
Print job, Reserve Print job, and Verify Print job.
Repeat Print Job
When you create a Repeat Print job, the job formats and
prints, but the printer stores the job in memory so you can
print additional copies of the job at a later time. As long as
the job remains stored in memory, you may print addi-
tional copies. Repeat Jobs are automatically deleted when
the printer requires extra memory to process additional
jobs or when the number of Repeat Jobs stored exceeds the
value of the setting for Print and Hold Repeat Job Limit. For
more information about this setting, refer to the Technical
Reference.
Reserve Print Job
When you create a Reserve Print job, the job formats, but
does not print. The printer stores the job in memory so
you can print the job at a later time. All pages in the job are
held in memory until you activate printing by using the
operator panel to select Print All Jobs or PRINT A JOB.
Reserve Print jobs are not deleted from memory when the
job prints. To delete a Reserve Print job, you must request
DELETE A JOB using the operator panel.
Understanding Print and Hold Jobs
109
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Verify Print Job
When you create a Verify Print job, the job formats, and
one copy of the job prints. Additional requested copies are
held in printer memory. You specify the number of copies
you want when you send the job from the printer driver.
This allows you to examine the first copy to see if it is sat-
isfactory before you print the other copies.
If the job is unsatisfactory, you would not want the other
copies to print. To delete the job, you must select the
DELETE A JOB value, and select this job to delete it. See
If the job is satisfactory, you can change the number of
copies to print or print the number of copies already set in
the printer driver.
To change the number of remaining copies to print:
1 Select PRINT COPIES.
2 Select the specific job.
3 At the Copies prompt, change the number of copies
to print from the number set in the printer driver
and press Select.
4 Press Return until you exit the menus or press Go to
exit the menus. Once the printer exits the menus
and returns to an online state, the remaining copies
print.
Once all copies are printed, the job is deleted from
printer memory. For more information, see PRINT
COPIES on page 69.
To print the number of copies set in the printer driver:
1 Select PRINT A JOB.
2 Select the specific job. The remaining copies print.
Once all copies are printed, the job is deleted from
printer memory. For more information, see PRINT A
Chapter 3: Using the Operator Panel and Menus
110
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Printing and Deleting
Held Jobs
Once you have sent a Repeat Print job, a Reserve Print job,
or a Verify Print job from the software application or the
printer driver and have selected a value in the HELD JOBS
menu item, the jobs are displayed on the operator panel in
lists. You may choose to delete all, delete one or more indi-
vidually, print all, print one or more individually, or print
multiple copies of a job.
•
•
To print one or more Held Jobs by selecting them
To print additional copies of a Held Job, see PRINT
COPIES on page 69.
68.
To delete one or more Held Jobs by selecting them
•
•
•
Entering a Once you send a Confidential Job from your software
application or printer driver, it is processed and held in
printer memory. A Personal Identification Number (PIN)
is paired with the print job in printer memory.
Personal
Identification
Number (PIN)
Entry of the PIN using the operator panel is required to
delete or print a Confidential Job.
When you want to access your Confidential Job held in
printer memory, you:
1 Press Menu> to enter the menus and go to the JOB
MENU.
If JOB MENU is on the first line of the display, con-
press Select.
2 Continue to press and release Menu> until you see
CONFIDENTIAL JOB on the second line of the dis-
play.
Entering a Personal Identification Number (PIN)
111
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
3 Press Select.
The following prompt appears on the display:
Enter PIN:
=____
You are required to enter the four-digit PIN associ-
ated with your Confidential Job next to the equal
sign (=). Each digit must be a number from 1 to 6.
At this point, the buttons on the operator panel
cease to function as before, such as scrolling
through the menus. You press the numbers on the
operator panel like pressing numbers on a calcula-
tor. To simplify the operator panel, the illustration
shows just the numbers and not the names of the
operator panel buttons.
As you press each button to enter each digit of your
PIN, an asterisk (*) appears on the display.
If you make a mistake entering your PIN, for
instance, if you enter a number incorrectly, con-
tinue to press any of the buttons until the mes-
sage No Jobs Found. Retry? displays. Press Go to
refresh the operator panel and the Enter PIN:
prompt displays again.
If you enter a PIN that does not match any Confi-
dential Job in printer memory, the message
No Jobs Found. Retry? displays. Press Go to
refresh the operator panel and display the
Enter PIN: prompt again or press Stop to cancel
the entry of a PIN.
Once you successfully enter the PIN, the printer
checks the PIN with each stored PIN associated
with each Confidential Job in printer memory. If the
number matches, you are given access to the next
level of the CONFIDENTIAL JOB menu item where
you can select to print or delete jobs matching the
PIN.
Note: If you enter the Enter
PIN prompt in error or need to
exit from this prompt, you must
wait until the No Jobs Found.
Retry? message displays and
then press Stop.
Chapter 3: Using the Operator Panel and Menus
112
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Print and Hold A lightning bolt symbol displays on the operator panel to
indicate a formatting error occurred on at least one type of
Print and Hold job. It looks like this:
Formatting Errors
When this type of error occurs, a portion of the processed
job may still print, so the printer does not discard the
entire job. Instead the lightning bolt displays to tell you
that there is a formatting error on the particular job.
Note: For documentation pur-
poses, Print and Hold jobs refers
to any of the following jobs: Con-
fidential Job, Repeat Print Job,
Reserve Print Job, and Verify
Print Job.
When any values are selected from either the CONFIDEN-
TIAL JOB menu item or the HELD JOBS menu item, the
symbol displays next to the value if at least one job experi-
ences a formatting error as shown:
HELD JOBS
CONFIDENTIAL JOB
Print All Jobs
Print All Jobs
CONFIDENTIAL JOB
PRINT A JOB
HELD JOBS
PRINT A JOB
CONFIDENTIAL JOB
Delete All Jobs
HELD JOBS
Delete All Jobs
CONFIDENTIAL JOB
DELETE A JOB
HELD JOBS
DELETE A JOB
CONFIDENTIAL JOB
PRINT COPIES
HELD JOBS
PRINT COPIES
Print and Hold Formatting Errors
113
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Once you select PRINT A JOB, DELETE A JOB, or
PRINT COPIES values in the CONFIDENTIAL JOB menu item
or the HELD JOBS menu item, the lightning bolt displays
by the value if the currently displayed job experiences a
formatting error. For example, if three jobs are sent to print
and the second job experiences a formatting error, when
you select PRINT COPIES, the operator panel displays as
follows as you use the Menu> button to scroll to each job:
PRINT COPIES
Job #1
PRINT COPIES
Job #2
PRINT COPIES
Job #3
The lightning bolt only displays for the second job since it
is the only job that encountered a formatting error.
Chapter 3: Using the Operator Panel and Menus
114
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Using Print
Materials
4
This chapter provides specifications and guidelines for
each type of print material that can be used with your
printer, as well as important information about the paper
sources and the output bins.
Multipurpose
Feeder
Your printer has two standard paper sources, the
250-sheet input tray and the multipurpose feeder, and two
output bins, providing high quality printing on a variety
of print materials from different paper sources.
Load the print material you use for the majority of your
print jobs in the 250-sheet input tray.
Reserve the multipurpose feeder for when you print on
different sizes and types of print material, such as card
stock, transparencies, postcards, note cards, and enve-
lopes. You may also want to use the multipurpose feeder
for single page print jobs on letterhead, or other special
print material you do not keep in an input tray.
250-Sheet Input Tray
Optional 500-Sheet Drawer
Note: You may purchase an
optional 500-sheet drawer as a
for installation information.
Using Print Materials
115
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Paper Sources The following table details the types and quantities of
media you can load in each of the paper sources. For more
and Sizes
information about selecting specific print material for use
list of the print material and envelope sizes your printer
supports.
Note: For detailed information
about print material characteris-
tics, refer to the Card Stock &
Label Guide on the CD that
comes with your printer.
Paper Source Specifications
Paper
1
2
Source
Media
Sizes
Weight
Capacity
2
2
Tray 1
(250-sheet input
tray)
Paper, labels,
transparencies
A4, JIS B5, letter, legal,
executive
60 to 90 g/m
(16 to 24 lb)
250 sheets paper
3
up to 100 labels
50 transparencies
500 sheets paper
Tray 2
(optional 500-sheet
drawer)
Paper only
A4, JIS B5, letter, legal,
executive
60 to 90 g/m
(16 to 24 lb)
2
Multipurpose feeder Paper, envelopes,
labels, transparencies,
Minimum: 69.85 x 127 mm 60 to 163 g/m 100 sheets paper
5
(2.75 x 5.0 in.)
(16 to 43 lb)
10 envelopes
4
card stock
Maximum: 215.9 x 356 mm
(8.5 x 14 in.)
30 labels
20 transparencies
10 sheets card stock
Supports all sizes listed in
1
This refers to paper only. For weights of other print materials, refer to the Card Stock & Label Guide for more infor-
mation.
2
3
4
5
For 20 lb print material, unless otherwise noted.
Refer to the Card Stock & Label Guide for more information.
3 x 5 in. and 4 x 6 in. index cards must exit to the rear output bin.
Print material 152.4 mm (6 in.) or less in length must exit to the rear output bin.
Chapter 4: Using Print Materials
116
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
The following table lists the paper and envelope sizes you
can use with your printer.
Paper and Envelope Dimensions
Paper
Dimensions
Envelope
Dimensions
A4
210 x 297 mm
(8.27 x 11.7 in.)
7 3/4 Envelope
(Monarch)
98.4 x 190.5 mm
(3.875 x 7.5 in.)
A5
148 x 210 mm
(5.83 x 8.27 in.)
9 Envelope
98.4 x 225.4 mm
(3.875 x 8.875 in.)
(Multipurpose feeder only)
JIS B5
Letter
182 x 257 mm
(7.17 x 10.12 in.)
10 Envelope
(Com-10)
104.8 x 241.3 mm
(4.125 x 9.5 in.)
215.9 x 279.4 mm
(8.5 x 11 in.)
DL Envelope
C5 Envelope
B5 Envelope
Other Envelope
110 x 220 mm
(4.33 x 8.66 in.)
Legal
215.9 x 356 mm
(8.5 x 14 in.)
162 x 229 mm
(6.38 x 9.01 in.)
Executive
184.2 x 266.7 mm
(7.25 x 10.5 in.)
176 x 250 mm
(6.93 x 9.84 in.)
1
2
Universal
(Multipurpose feeder only)
215.9 x 356 mm
(8.5 x 14 in.)
229.11 x 356 mm
(9.02 x 14 in.)
1
Select this value when using a non-standard size sheet of print material. The printer formats the page for the
maximum size (8.5 x 14 in.). Set the actual size from your software application.
2
Select this value when using a non-standard size of envelope. The printer formats the envelope for the maximum
size (9.02 x 14 in.). Set the actual size from your software application.
Paper Sources and Sizes
117
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Print Material Selecting the appropriate print material (paper, transpar-
encies, envelopes, labels, and card stock) for your printer
helps you avoid printing problems.
Guidelines
The following sections contain guidelines for choosing the
correct print material for your printer.
Note: For detailed information
about print material characteris-
tics, refer to the Card Stock &
Label Guide on the CD that
comes with your printer.
Paper
For the best print quality, use 75 g/ m2 (20 lb) xerographic,
grain long paper. Try a sample of any paper you are con-
sidering using with the printer before buying large quanti-
ties.
When loading paper, note the recommended print side on
the paper package, and load paper accordingly. See
instructions.
The following papers are not recommended for use with
your printer:
•
•
•
Paper with a rough or heavily textured surface
Coated papers, such as erasable bond
Preprinted papers manufactured with chemicals
that may contaminate the printer
•
•
•
•
Multiple-part forms
Synthetic papers
Thermal papers
Recycled paper having a weight less than 75 g/ m2
(20 lb)
Letterhead
Preprinted papers such as letterhead must be able to with-
stand temperatures up to 200°C (392°F) without melting
or releasing hazardous emissions. Use inks that are not
affected by the resin in toner or the silicone in the fuser.
Inks that are oxidation-set or oil-based should meet these
requirements; latex inks might not.
Chapter 4: Using Print Materials
118
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Transparencies
You can feed transparencies from the 250-sheet input tray
or the multipurpose feeder. Try a sample of any transpar-
encies you are considering using with the printer before
buying large quantities.
Do not load transparencies in the optional 500-sheet
drawer. To load transparencies in the 250-sheet input tray,
When printing on transparencies:
Warning! When printing on
transparencies, be sure to set
the PAPER TYPE to Transpar-
ency from the printer driver, and
from either the operator panel or
from MarkVision to avoid dam-
aging your printer.
•
Use transparencies designed specifically for laser
printers. Transparencies must be able to withstand
temperatures of 175°C (347°F) without melting, dis-
coloring or releasing hazardous emissions.
•
•
To prevent print quality problems, avoid getting fin-
gerprints on the transparencies.
Before loading transparencies, fan the stack to pre-
vent sheets from sticking together.
Envelopes
You can load up to 10 envelopes in the multipurpose
feeder. Try a sample of any envelopes you are considering
using with the printer before buying large quantities. See
page 141 for loading instructions.
When printing on envelopes:
Note: When printing on enve-
lopes, be sure to set the PAPER
SOURCE to MP Feeder or
Manual Env, set the PAPER TYPE
to Envelope, and select the cor-
rect envelope size from the
printer driver, and from either the
operator panel or from
•
Use envelopes made from 75 to 105 g/ m2 (20 to
28 lb) bond paper. For best performance and fewer
paper jams, do not use envelopes that:
– Have excessive curl.
– Are stuck together.
– Are damaged in any way.
– Contain windows, holes, perforations, cutouts or
embossing.
MarkVision.
– Use metal clasps, string ties, or metal folding
bars.
– Have postage stamps attached.
– Have any exposed adhesive when the flap is in
the sealed or closed position.
Print Material Guidelines
119
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
•
Use envelopes that can withstand temperatures of
205°C (401°F) without sealing, excessive curling,
wrinkling, or releasing hazardous emissions.
•
•
Adjust the right paper guide to fit the width of the
envelopes.
Load envelopes with the flap side down and the
short edge nearest the return address positioned to
tion for loading envelopes.
•
If you are feeding self-sealing envelopes, open the
rear output bin door so envelopes feed straight out
the back of the printer. The rear output bin holds
about 10 envelopes.
Labels
Your printer can print on many labels designed for use
with laser printers. These labels are supplied in letter-size
and A4-size sheets. Label adhesives, face sheet (printable
stock), and topcoats must be able to withstand tempera-
tures of 205°C (401°F) and pressure of 25 pounds per
square inch (psi).
Try a sample of any labels you are considering using with
the printer before purchasing a large quantity.
For detailed information on label printing, characteristics
and design, refer to the Card Stock & Label Guide on the CD
that comes with your printer.
When printing on labels:
Note: When printing on labels,
be sure to set the PAPER TYPE
to Labels from the printer driver,
and from either the operator
panel or from MarkVision.
•
Do not load labels together with paper or transpar-
encies in the same paper source.
•
•
•
Do not use label sheets with a slick backing material.
Do not print within 1 mm (0.040 in.) of the die cut.
Use full label sheets. Partial sheets may cause labels
to peel off during printing, resulting in a paper jam.
Partial sheets will also contaminate your printer
and your cartridge with adhesive, and could void
your printer and cartridge warranties.
Chapter 4: Using Print Materials
120
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
•
•
•
Use labels that can withstand temperatures of 205°C
(401°F) without sealing, excessive curling, wrin-
kling, or releasing hazardous emissions.
Do not print within 1 mm (0.040 in.) of the edge of
the label, of the perforations, or between die-cuts of
the label.
Do not use label sheets that have adhesive to the
edge of the sheet. We recommend zone coating of
the adhesive at least 1 mm (0.040 in.) away from
edges. Adhesive material will contaminate your
printer and could void your warranty.
•
If zone coating of the adhesive is not possible, a
3 mm (0.125 in.) strip should be removed on the
leading and driver edge, and a non-oozing adhesive
should be used.
•
•
Remove a 3 mm (0.125 in.) strip from the leading
edge to prevent labels from peeling inside the
printer.
Portrait orientation is preferred, especially when
printing bar codes.
•
•
Do not use labels that have exposed adhesive.
You may feed vinyl labels from the 250-sheet input
tray and the multipurpose feeder.
After continuously printing approximately 10,000 pages
of labels (or each time you replace the print cartridge),
complete the following steps to maintain printer feeding
reliability:
1 Print 5 sheets of paper.
2 Wait approximately 5 seconds.
3 Print 5 more sheets of paper.
Print Material Guidelines
121
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Card Stock Card stock is single ply, and has a large array of proper-
ties, such as the orientation of paper fibers and texture,
that can significantly affect the print quality.
Guidelines
Try a sample of any card stock you are considering using
with the printer before purchasing a large quantity.
print materials.
When printing on card stock:
Note: When printing on card
stock, be sure to set the PAPER
TYPE to Card Stock from the
printer driver, and from either the
operator panel or from MarkVi-
sion.
•
Use card stock that can withstand temperatures of
205°C (401°F) without sealing, excessive curling,
wrinkling, or releasing hazardous emissions.
•
Do not use preprinted card stock manufactured
with chemicals that may contaminate the printer.
Preprinting introduces semi-liquid and volatile
components in the printer.
•
•
Do not use card stock that is perforated or creased. It
may cause paper jams.
We recommend the use of grain short card stock.
After printing approximately 10,000 pages of card stock
(or each time you replace the print cartridge), complete
the following steps to maintain printer feeding reliability:
1 Print 5 sheets of paper.
2 Wait approximately 5 seconds.
3 Print 5 more sheets of paper.
For detailed information on card stock printing, character-
istics, and design, refer to the Card Stock & Label Guide on
the CD.
Chapter 4: Using Print Materials
122
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Storing Print Use the following guidelines for proper print material
storage:
Material
•
For best results, store print material in an environ-
ment where the temperature is approximately 21°C
(70°F) and the relative humidity is 40%.
•
•
Store cartons of print material on a pallet or shelf,
rather than directly on the floor.
If you store individual packages of print material,
make sure they rest on a flat surface so the edges do
not buckle or curl.
•
Do not place anything on top of the print material
packages.
Storing Print Material
123
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Loading Proper print material loading helps prevent paper jams
and helps make your printing trouble-free.
Print Material
Do not remove input trays while a job is printing or while
Busy displays on the operator panel. Doing so may cause a
paper jam.
Before loading print material, know the recommended
print side of the print material you are using. This infor-
mation is usually indicated on the print material package.
Loading an
Input Tray
Your printer has one standard 250-sheet input tray that
holds five paper sizes: A4, B5, LTR (Letter), LGL (Legal),
and EXE (Executive). The 250-sheet input tray also holds
labels or transparencies.
You may purchase an optional 500-sheet drawer as a
page 223 for installation information.
To load print material in an input tray:
1 Pull the input tray straight out of the printer.
If you are loading the 250-sheet input tray, pull the
input tray straight out and remove it completely
from the printer.
If you are loading the input tray for the optional
500-sheet drawer, pull the input tray straight out
and remove it completely from the support unit.
Chapter 4: Using Print Materials
124
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2 Press down on the metal plate until it locks into
place.
The metal plate remains stationary on the inside
bottom of the input tray.
3 Move the length guide to the correct position for
Paper Size
Indicators
Length Guide
the size print material you are loading.
– For the 250-sheet input tray, press down on the
length guide tab with one hand, and with the
other hand slide the length guide to the correct
position for the size print material you are load-
ing.
Length
Guide
Tab
Paper Size
Indicators
Loading Print Material
125
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
– For the 500-sheet input tray, lift the length guide
straight up out of the input tray and replace it in
the correct position.
Length Guide
Paper Size
Indicators
Insert the tabs located on each end of the length
guide into the slots on the side of the input tray.
Note: These examples show
how to adjust for letter-size
paper (LTR). The paper size
indicators are paper size abbre-
viations used for placement of
the length guide as shown.
4 Press down on the width guide tab and slide the
width guide to the far right side of the input tray
as shown.
Width Guide Tab
Width Guide
Chapter 4: Using Print Materials
126
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
5 Flex the sheets back and forth to loosen them, then
fan them. Do not fold or crease the print material.
Straighten the edges on a level surface.
6 Place the print material against the left side of the
input tray and insert it under the metal stop.
Make sure the recommended print side is face down
and the front edge is placed toward the front of the
input tray.
Metal Stop
Note: Make sure the print
material fits easily under the
metal stop and is not bent or
wrinkled. Do not raise the metal
stop or force print material under
the metal stop.
Loading Print Material
127
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
7 Do not exceed the maximum stack height indi-
cated by the line under the arrows.
Note: Overfilling the input tray
may cause paper jams.
8 Push on the right side of the width guide to move
it to the left until it lightly touches the edge of the
print material.
Width Guide
Note: Sliding the width guide
too tight against the print mate-
rial may cause misfeeds.
Chapter 4: Using Print Materials
128
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
9 Insert the input tray.
Slide the input tray all the way into the printer until
it snaps into place.
Slide the 500-sheet input tray all the way into the
support unit.
10 Send your job to print.
Loading Print Material
129
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Loading the
Multipurpose Feeder
Your printer has one standard multipurpose feeder that
holds several sizes and types of print material, such as
paper, card stock, transparencies, postcards, note cards,
and envelopes. You can load approximately 100 sheets of
75 g/m2 (20 lb) paper at a time. You can also load approxi-
mately 10 envelopes or 20 transparencies at a time.
You may also want to use the multipurpose feeder for sin-
gle page print jobs on letterhead or other special print
material you do not keep in an input tray.
Note: When printing from the
multipurpose feeder, be sure to
set the PAPER SIZE and PAPER
TYPE for the MP Feeder menu
item. Also select the paper size
and type from your software
application.
For information on the types of print material that you can
Complete the following instructions to load print material
in the multipurpose feeder:
information.
2 Slide the paper width guide to the far right side of
the multipurpose feeder.
Paper
Width Guide
Chapter 4: Using Print Materials
130
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
3 Flex the sheets back and forth to loosen them, then
fan them. Do not fold or crease the print material.
Straighten the edges on a level surface.
Note: Do not load different
sizes or types of print material in
the multipurpose feeder at the
same time. Doing so may cause
a paper jam.
4 Locate the stack height limiter on the left side of
the printer.
5 Place the print material against the left side of the
multipurpose feeder with the recommended print
side face up and the top edge going in first toward
the printer.
Stack Height Limiter
Note: Do not exceed the maxi-
mum stack height limiter located
on the left side of the multipur-
pose feeder.
Loading Print Material
131
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 Slide the print material into the multipurpose
feeder as far as it will go. Do not force it. Forcing
print material could cause a paper jam.
7 Slide the paper width guide to the left until it
lightly touches the edge of the print material.
Paper
Width Guide
Make sure the print material fits loosely in the mul-
tipurpose feeder and is not bent or wrinkled. Do not
overload the multipurpose feeder.
8 Send your job to print.
Chapter 4: Using Print Materials
132
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Using the You printer has two standard paper exits. The following
sections explain how to use the printer output bins.
Paper Exits
(Output Bins)
Using the
Standard Output Bin
The standard output bin holds 250 sheets of print material
and is located on top of the printer. The printer automati-
cally sends print jobs to the standard output bin.
The standard output bin collates print jobs face down.
Standard Output Bin
Using the Paper Exits (Output Bins)
133
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Using the
Rear Output Bin
You may want to use the rear output bin when you print on
different sizes and types of print material, such as paper, card
stock, transparencies, postcards, note cards, and envelopes.
The rear output bin holds 20 sheets of paper. For information
on other types of print material, refer to the Card Stock & Label
Guide.
The printer automatically sends print jobs to the rear out-
put bin when you open it. The rear output bin reverse col-
lates print jobs face up.
Note: Print material that is
165.1 mm (6.5 in.) or less in
length must exit to the rear out-
put bin.
1 Locate the rear output bin door as shown.
Handhold
Rear Output
Bin Door
2 Pull the handhold to open the rear output bin.
3 Close the rear output bin door when you finish
using it.
Chapter 4: Using Print Materials
134
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Printing on Check with the manufacturer or vendor to determine
whether the preprinted letterhead you have chosen is
acceptable for laser printers.
Letterhead
Page orientation is important when printing on letterhead.
Use the following table for help when loading letterhead
in the paper sources.
Orienting Letterhead
Top of page
Tray
Print side Portrait
Landscape
Tray 1
(250-sheet input tray)
Face down Front of tray Left side of
(nearest tray tray
handle)
Tray 2
(optional 500-sheet
drawer)
Multipurpose feeder
(including feeding
individual sheets)
Face up
Rear of tray Left side of
(enters the
printer first)
tray
Tray Linking If you are using the same size and type of print material in
all paper sources (input trays and the multipurpose
feeder) and the PAPER MENU settings for the sources are
the same, the automatic tray linking feature is enabled.
For example, if you have the same size and type print
material loaded in the standard 250-sheet tray and the
optional 500-sheet drawer, the printer will select print
material from one tray when the other becomes empty.
If you load the same size print material in each tray, make
sure the print material is all the same type. If you use dif-
ferent print material in the trays, each source with a differ-
ent print material must have the PAPER TYPE set to a
unique value to disable the automatic tray linking feature.
Printing on Letterhead
135
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Manual Duplex Manual duplex printing lets you print on both sides of
paper and card stock.
Printing
Manual duplexing does not damage your printer, but
print quality and feed reliability may vary when printing
on the other side of the page.
To print on both sides of paper and card stock (called
duplex printing or two-sided printing), print the first side of
the print material like any other print job. When printing
on the other side of the page, set PAPER WEIGHT to Heavy
in the PAPER MENU to achieve the best results.
Make sure the placement or orientation of the print mate-
rial is correct.
Duplex Printing from
the Multipurpose
Feeder
When printing letterhead paper from the multipurpose
feeder, load it with the design face up, so the top edge of
the sheet with the logo enters the printer first.
To print the second side of the sheet, load the printed side
face down with the top edge of the sheet facing toward the
printer.
Duplex Printing from
the Trays
When printing letterhead paper from the trays, load it
with the design face down with the top edge of the sheet
facing toward the front of the printer.
To print the second side of the sheet, load the printed side
face up with the top edge of the sheet facing toward the
front of the printer.
Chapter 4: Using Print Materials
136
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Paper Jams
page 124, you are well on your way to trouble-free print-
ing. If jams do occur, however, follow the steps outlined in
make sure you are following these tips:
•
•
Note: Make sure the PAPER
TYPE, PAPER TEXTURE, and
PAPER WEIGHT settings in the
PAPER MENU are correct.
If you need to load print material in a tray while a
job is printing, press the Stop button and wait for
the printer motors to idle before you remove the
tray from the printer. After you reinstall the loaded
tray, press Go to continue printing.
•
•
Do not load wrinkled, creased, damp, or curled
print material.
Flex, fan, and straighten the print material before
you load it. If jams do occur, try manually feeding
the print material one sheet at a time.
•
Do not overload the paper sources. Make sure the
print material does not exceed the maximum height
indicated on the stack height indicator.
•
•
Do not use print material that you have cut or
trimmed yourself.
Do not mix print material sizes, weights, or types in
the same paper source.
•
•
Do not use coated print materials.
Make sure the recommended print side is face down
when loading all input trays and the recommended
print side is face up when loading the multipurpose
feeder.
•
•
Keep print materials stored in an acceptable
Do not remove input trays during a print job.
Avoiding Paper Jams
137
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Chapter 4: Using Print Materials
138
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Multipurpose
Feeder
5
The multipurpose feeder is located on the front of your
printer. It can be closed when you are not using it, making
the printer more compact.
You may want to use the multipurpose feeder when you
print on different sizes and types of print material, such as
paper, card stock, transparencies, postcards, note cards,
and envelopes. You may also want to use the multipur-
pose feeder for single-page print jobs on letterhead, or
other special print material you do not keep in a paper
tray.
You can load approximately 100 sheets of 75 g/m2 (20 lb)
print material at a time. You can load approximately 10
envelopes or 20 transparencies at a time.
The maximum stack height for the loading of any print
material is 10 mm (0.4 in.). Print material is loaded face up
in the multipurpose feeder.
Multipurpose Feeder
The multipurpose feeder accepts print material within the
following dimensions:
Minimum
Maximum
Width
69.85 mm (2.75 in.)
127 mm (5 in.)
229.11 mm (9.02 in.)
355.6 mm (14 in.)
Length
Multipurpose Feeder
139
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
When printing from the multipurpose feeder, be sure to
set the PAPER SIZE and PAPER TYPE for the MP Feeder
menu item. Also, select the size and paper type from your
software application for the print material you have
page 47 for more information.
Multipurpose Follow these guidelines when using the multipurpose
feeder:
Feeder Guidelines
•
•
Load only one size and type of print material or
envelopes at a time in the multipurpose feeder.
To achieve the best possible print quality, use only
high-quality print material that is designed for use
material.
•
•
To prevent paper jams, do not add print material to
the multipurpose feeder until it is empty.
Do not close the multipurpose feeder while a job is
printing or while Busy displays on the operator
panel. Doing so may cause a paper jam.
•
•
Load print material with the top edge going into the
multipurpose feeder first.
Do not place objects on the multipurpose feeder.
Also, avoid pressing down or applying excessive
force on it.
Chapter 5: Multipurpose Feeder
140
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Opening the To open the multipurpose feeder door:
Multipurpose
Feeder
1 Push the lower release latch on the front left side
to release the multipurpose feeder door.
The multipurpose feeder door is the same as the
lower front door.
The multipurpose feeder door opens and stops in
place.
Opening the Multipurpose Feeder
141
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2 Locate the metal bar in the recessed area on the
multipurpose feeder.
3 Pull the metal bar straight out to extend the multi-
purpose feeder.
Note: Extend the metal bar to
its full-length position to hold
longer print material.
Chapter 5: Multipurpose Feeder
142
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Loading the Proper loading prevents paper jams and ensures
trouble-free printing. The following sections give detailed
instructions for loading.
Multipurpose
Feeder
Note: Note the recommended
print side label on the print
material package and load print
material accordingly.
Loading Print
Material
1 Locate the icons on the multipurpose feeder sur-
face. These icons show the correct orientation for
loading paper, as well as how to load letterhead and
envelopes.
Simplex
Envelope
Loading the Multipurpose Feeder
143
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2 Slide the paper width guide to the far right side of
Paper
Width Guide
the multipurpose feeder.
3 Prepare specific print material for loading:
– Flex sheets of paper back and forth to loosen
them, and then fan them. Do not fold or crease
the paper. Straighten the edges on a level surface.
– Hold transparencies by the edges and fan them
to prevent feeding failures.
Note: Avoid touching the print
side of the transparencies. Be
careful not to scratch them.
Chapter 5: Multipurpose Feeder
144
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
– Fan envelopes back and forth to loosen them. Do
not fold or crease the envelopes. Straighten the
edges on a level surface.
4 Locate the stack height limiter on the left side of
the multipurpose feeder.
5 Place the print material against the left side of the
multipurpose feeder. Do not mix different sizes and
types of print material.
Stack Height Limiter
Loading the Multipurpose Feeder
145
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 Load specific print material:
– Load paper with the recommended print side
face up and the top edge going in first as shown.
Note: Do not exceed the maxi-
mum stack height limiter located
on the left side of the multipur-
pose feeder. Overfilling the mul-
tipurpose feeder may cause
paper jams.
– Load letterhead with the design face up and the
top edge going in first as shown.
Chapter 5: Multipurpose Feeder
146
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
– Load transparencies with the recommended
print side face up and the top edge going in first
as shown.
– Load envelopes with the flap side down and the
stamp area end going in last as shown.
Do not feed stamped envelopes into the multi-
purpose feeder. The stamp is shown for place-
ment only.
Note: For best results, self-
sealing envelopes should exit to
the rear output bin.
Warning! Never use enve-
lopes with clasps, snaps, win-
dows, coated linings, or self-
stick adhesives. These enve-
lopes may severely damage the
printer.
Loading the Multipurpose Feeder
147
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
7 Slide the print material into the multipurpose
feeder as far as it will go. Do not force it. Forcing
print material could cause a paper jam.
Note: If envelopes jam while
printing, try reducing the number
of envelopes you load.
8 Slide the paper width guide to the left until it
lightly touches the edge of the print material.
Paper
Width Guide
Make sure the print material fits loosely in the mul-
tipurpose feeder and is not bent or wrinkled. Do not
overload the multipurpose feeder.
Chapter 5: Multipurpose Feeder
148
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Using the After loading print material in the multipurpose feeder,
select the paper source from your software application,
and then select the paper size and type from both your
software application and from the operator panel.
Multipurpose
Feeder
To set the operator panel:
Note: Software settings may
override operator panel settings.
1 Make sure the PAPER SIZE for the multipurpose
feeder (MP Feeder Size) is set to the correct size for
the print material you are loading.
2 Make sure the PAPER TYPE for the multipurpose
feeder (MP Feeder Type) is set to the correct value
for the print material you are loading.
3 Make sure the PAPER LENGTH for the PAPER TYPE
in the multipurpose feeder is set to the correct
value for the print material you are loading.
Print material 152.4 mm (6 in.) or less in length must
4 Press Go to return the printer to the Ready state.
Using the Multipurpose Feeder
149
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Closing the When you finish printing with the multipurpose feeder:
Multipurpose
Feeder
1 Remove all print material.
2 Push the metal bar straight back to collapse the
multipurpose feeder to its short-length position.
3 Close the multipurpose feeder door.
4 Close the rear output bin if you were printing on
print material 152.4 mm (6 in.) or less in length.
Chapter 5: Multipurpose Feeder
150
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Understanding
Printer
Messages
6
This chapter describes the various messages that may
appear on your operator panel display. Status messages
give information about the current state of the printer.
Attendance messages indicate printer errors that you must
resolve. Service messages indicate printer failures that may
require servicing.
Note: For documentation pur-
poses, Print and Hold jobs refers
to any of the following jobs: Con-
fidential Job, Reserve Print Job,
Repeat Print Job, and Verify
Print Job.
Status Messages The first line (line 1) on the display provides information
on the current state or status of the printer, as shown in the
message is long enough that it requires both lines to dis-
play the entire message.
Usually the second line (line 2) on the display provides
Status Messages
151
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Line 1 Messages
Status Message
Meaning and Actions Allowed While Message Displays
Activating Menu
Changes
The printer is reset to activate a printer setting change.
No button actions are possible while this message displays.
Busy
<warning>
The printer is busy receiving, processing, or printing data. The printer indicator light
blinks while the printer is processing data.
The display shows one of the following items on line 1 while the printer processes
data:
•
•
•
A PJL RDYMSG, if it is defined
A Network Printing Alliance (NPA) protocol job name, if one is defined
The printer language
Note: If you use a PJL RDYMSG command or an NPA protocol job name, a
customized message may display instead of Busy.
Note: The printer language appears on line 1 to the right of the Busy message.
•
Press Stop to take the printer out of the Busy state. The Not Ready message
displays. No more data is processed, but all print material in the printer paper path
prints. Press Go to return to Busy and continue receiving, processing, or printing
data.
•
•
•
Cancel the current job. Press Menu> or <Menu. The JOB MENU displays. Press
Menu> or <Menu until Cancel Job appears on the second line of the operator panel
display. Press Select.
Reset the printer. Press Menu> or <Menu. The JOB MENU displays. Press Menu>
or <Menu until Reset Printer appears on the second line of the operator panel
display. Press Select.
Print or delete Print and Hold jobs. Press Menu> or <Menu. The JOB MENU
displays. Press Menu> or <Menu until CONFIDENTIAL JOB or HELD JOBS
delete a job.
For more information, refer to the Technical Reference.
Note: Resetting the printer deletes all current data from the print buffer, including all
Cancelling Job
The printer is processing a request to cancel the current print job.
Clearing Job
Accounting Stat
The printer is deleting all job statistics stored on the hard disk option.
No button actions are possible while this message displays.
Defragmenting
DO NOT POWER OFF
The printer is defragmenting the flash memory option to reclaim storage space
occupied by deleted resources.
No button actions are possible while this message displays.
Chapter 6: Understanding Printer Messages
152
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Status Message
Deleting Jobs
Meaning and Actions Allowed While Message Displays
The printer is deleting one or more Print and Hold jobs. This message displays if you
selected Delete All Jobs or DELETE A JOB, and there are no other print jobs selected
for printing.
Queuing and
Deleting Jobs
The printer is deleting one or more Print and Hold jobs and printing one or more Print
and Hold jobs. This message displays if one or more print jobs are selected for
deletion in the CONFIDENTIAL JOB and HELD JOBS menu items, and one or more
print jobs are selected for printing.
No button actions are possible while either of these messages displays.
page 68 for more information.
Disabling Menus
Enabling Menus
This message briefly displays after the operator panel menus have been disabled. See
No button actions are possible while this message displays.
If the operator panel menus are disabled, this message briefly displays after they are
No button actions are possible while this message displays.
Flushing Buffer
Formatting Disk
The printer is flushing corrupted print data and discarding the current print job.
No button actions are possible while this message displays.
The hard disk option is formatting.
This message also displays if you select the Discard value for the Buffered Jobs menu
item in the CONFIG MENU.
No button actions are possible while this message displays.
Note: Do not power Off (O) the printer while this message displays.
Formatting Flash
The flash memory option is formatting.
DO NOT POWER OFF
No button actions are possible while this message displays.
Note: Do not power Off (O) the printer while this message displays.
Invalid
Network 1 Code
This message displays if the code in the optional internal print server (also called an
internal network adapter or INA) has not been programmed or if the code is not valid.
You can download network code while this message displays.
When this message appears, the Ready and Busy messages do not display until valid
code is programmed into the optional internal print server.
No button actions are possible while this message displays.
Menus Disabled
The printer menus are disabled. This message displays when Menu> or <Menu is
pressed.
No button actions are possible while this message displays.
Status Messages
153
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Status Message
Meaning and Actions Allowed While Message Displays
Network Card
Busy
The optional internal print server is being reset. The Network 1 Setup menu item in the
NETWORK MENU is not available while this message displays.
No button actions are possible while this message displays.
Not Ready
The printer is in the Not Ready state, which means it is not ready to receive or process
data.
•
•
Press Go to take the printer out of the Not Ready state.
Cancel the current job. Press Menu> or <Menu. The JOB MENU displays. Press
Menu> or <Menu until Cancel Job appears on the second line of the operator panel
display. Press Select.
•
Reset the printer. Press Menu> or <Menu. The JOB MENU displays. Press Menu>
or <Menu until Reset Printer appears on the second line of the operator panel
display. Press Select.
Note: Resetting the printer deletes all current data from the print buffer, including all
Performing
Self Test
The printer is running the normal series of start-up tests after it is powered On (|).
When the tests are complete, the printer returns to the Ready state.
No button actions are possible while this message display.
The printer is in Power Saver mode.
Power Saver
<warning>
•
•
•
Press Go to take the printer out of Power Saver mode.
Press Menu> or <Menu to enter the menus.
Press Stop to take the printer offline. The Not Ready message displays. No data is
processed. Press Go to return the printer to Power Saver.
Chapter 6: Understanding Printer Messages
154
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Status Message
Meaning and Actions Allowed While Message Displays
Printing
Directory List
The printer is processing or printing a directory of all files stored in the flash memory
option or on the hard disk option.
Printing Font
List
The printer is processing or printing a list of all available fonts for the selected printer
language.
Printing Job
The printer is processing or printing the Job Accounting Statistics.
Accounting Stat
Printing Menu
Settings
The message displays until the function completes and the page prints.
•
•
•
Press Stop to take the printer offline. The Not Ready message displays. No more
data is processed, but all print material in the printer paper path prints. Press Go to
return to the previous message.
Cancel the current job. Press Menu> or <Menu. The JOB MENU displays. Press
Menu> or <Menu until Cancel Job appears on the second line of the operator panel
display. Press Select.
Reset the printer. Press Menu> or <Menu. The JOB MENU displays. Press Menu>
or <Menu until Reset Printer appears on the second line of the operator panel
display. Press Select.
Note: Resetting the printer deletes all current data from the print buffer, including all
Printing Quality
Test Pages
The printer is formatting the Print Quality Test Pages once Prt Quality Pgs is selected
in the CONFIG MENU. Once the pages start printing, the Busy message displays.
No button actions are possible while this message displays.
Program Flash
DO NOT POWER OFF
The printer is storing resources, fonts or macros, in the flash memory option. If infor-
mation is written to the flash memory option and to the hard disk option at the same
time, the Program Flash message displays.
No button actions are possible while this message displays.
Note: Do not power Off (O) the printer while this message displays.
Programming Disk
DO NOT POWER OFF
The printer is storing resources, fonts or macros, on the hard disk option. If information
is written to the flash memory option and to the hard disk option at the same time, the
Program Flash message displays.
No button actions are possible while this message displays.
Note: Do not power Off (O) the printer while this message displays.
Status Messages
155
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Status Message
Queuing Jobs
Meaning and Actions Allowed While Message Displays
The printer is processing one or more Print and Hold jobs selected for printing. This
message displays if you selected PRINT A JOB, Print All Jobs, or PRINT COPIES and
no jobs are selected for deletion.
Queuing and
Deleting Jobs
The printer is processing one or more Print and Hold jobs selected for printing and
deleting one or more Print and Hold jobs. This message displays if you selected one or
more jobs to print using PRINT A JOB, Print All Jobs, or PRINT COPIES values in the
CONFIDENTIAL JOB or HELD JOBS menu items, and one or more jobs are selected
for deletion.
No button actions are possible while either of these messages displays.
Ready
The printer is ready to receive and process data.
<warning>
•
Press Menu> or <Menu to take the printer out of the Ready state and enter the
menus.
•
Press Stop to take the printer offline. The Not Ready message displays. No data is
processed. Press Go to return the printer to the Ready state.
Note: If you use the PJL RDYMSG command, a customized message may display
instead of Ready.
Note: If Power Saver is set to On and is active, Power Saver displays instead of Ready.
For more information, refer to the Technical Reference.
Ready
<warning>
Hex
The printer is ready and Hex Trace mode is active. Hex Trace isolates the source of a
print job problem. When Hex Trace is selected, all data sent to the printer prints in
hexadecimal and character representation. Control codes print, but do not execute.
•
•
Power Off (O) the printer to exit Hex Trace.
Press Stop to take the printer offline. The Not Ready message displays, and no
data is processed. Press Go to return the printer to the Ready state.
Reset the printer. Press Menu> or <Menu. The JOB MENU displays. Press Menu>
or <Menu until Reset Printer appears on the second line of the operator panel
display. Press Select.
•
Note: Resetting the printer deletes all current data from the print buffer, including all
Chapter 6: Understanding Printer Messages
156
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Status Message
Meaning and Actions Allowed While Message Displays
Res Reduced
<warning>
The resolution of the page is reduced from 600 dots per inch (dpi) to 300 dpi to prevent
a 38 Memory Full error. Res Reduced displays for the duration of the current job. The
printer indicator light blinks while the printer is processing data.
•
Press Stop to take the printer out of the Res Reduced state. The Not Ready
message displays. Press Go to return to Res Reduced.
•
Cancel the current job. Press Menu> or <Menu. The JOB MENU displays. Press
Menu> or <Menu until Cancel Job appears on the second line of the operator panel
display. Press Select.
Resetting the
Printer
The printer is deleting any print jobs in process and restoring all printer settings to user
defaults.
No button actions are possible while this message displays.
Restoring
Factory Defaults
The printer is restoring factory defaults. Factory defaults are restored by selecting
Factory Defaults in the UTILITIES MENU or by selecting Factory Defaults in the
CONFIG MENU.
No button actions are possible while this message displays.
Waiting
Waiting displays when one of the following occurs:
<warning>
•
•
The printer has received a page of data to print, but is waiting for an End of Job
command, Form Feed command, or for additional data. Waiting displays until the
Print Timeout occurs or additional data is received.
When Collation is set to On, but the print job has not been canceled. Termination of
the print job is required before page collated copies print.
Note: The printer language appears on line 1 to the right of the Waiting message.
•
•
Press Go to print the contents of the buffer.
Press Stop to take the printer out of the Waiting state. The Not Ready message
displays. Press Go to return to Waiting.
•
•
Cancel the current job. Press Menu> or <Menu. The JOB MENU displays. Press
Menu> or <Menu until Cancel Job appears on the second line of the operator panel
display. Press Select.
Reset the printer. Press Menu> or <Menu. The JOB MENU displays. Press Menu>
or <Menu until Reset Printer appears on the second line of the operator panel
display. Press Select.
Note: Resetting the printer deletes all current data from the print buffer, including all
Status Messages
157
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Warning Messages
Warning messages give further information about printer
status. The following is an example of a warning message
displayed on the operator panel when the printer is in the
Ready state:
Ready
Tray 1 Missing
In this example, Tray 1 Missing is the warning message.
The following table lists messages that appear on the sec-
ond line of the operator panel display. If none of the fol-
lowing conditions exist, line 2 of the operator panel
display is blank.
Status Message
Meaning
Fax 1
The printer is processing a fax through the optional interface.
The optional infrared interface is the active communication link.
The optional LocalTalk interface is the active communication link.
The optional network interface is the active communication link.
The standard parallel interface is the active communication link.
The optional parallel interface is the active communication link.
The optional serial interface is the active communication link.
The 250-sheet input tray is missing.
Infrared 1
LocalTalk 1
Network 1
Parallel
Parallel 1
Serial 1
Tray 1 Missing
Tray 1 Missing is available only if the optional 500-sheet drawer is installed. See
USB
The standard USB interface is the active communication link.
The optional USB interface is the active communication link.
USB 1
Chapter 6: Understanding Printer Messages
158
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Attendance Attendance messages indicate printer errors that you
must resolve before you can continue printing. The mes-
sages are listed in numerical then alphabetical order.
Messages
Note: For paper jam errors,
the entire paper path must be
cleared of print material. See
more information.
Attendance Message
Meaning and Required Action
34 Short Paper
The printer determines the paper length is too short to print the formatted data. This
occurs when the printer does not know the actual paper size loaded in tray. This
message also displays if you select Universal as a Paper Size setting and use print
material too short for the page format.
•
•
Press Go to clear the message and continue printing.
Make sure the Paper Size setting in the PAPER MENU is correct for the size print
material you are using. If the MP Feeder Size setting is set to Universal, make sure
your print material is large enough.
•
•
Cancel the current job. Press Menu> or <Menu. The JOB MENU displays. Press
Menu> or <Menu until Cancel Job appears on the second line of the operator panel
display. Press Select.
Reset the printer. Press Menu> or <Menu. The JOB MENU displays. Press Menu>
or <Menu until Reset Printer appears on the second line of the operator panel
display. Press Select.
Note: Resetting the printer deletes all current data from the print buffer, including all
35 Res Save Off
The printer lacks the memory needed to enable Resource Save. This message usually
Deficient Memory
indicates that too much memory is allocated for one or more of the printer link buffers.
To enable Resource Save after this message displays:
•
•
Install additional memory, or
Set the link buffer back to Auto, and exit the menus to activate the link buffer
changes. When Ready displays, enable Resource Save from the SETUP MENU.
Press Go to disable Resource Save and continue printing.
Attendance Messages
159
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Attendance Message
Meaning and Required Action
37 Insufficient
Collation Area
The printer memory used to store pages of data is too full to collate the rest of the print
job.
•
Press Go to clear the message, print the portion of the job already in memory, and
begin collating the rest of the job.
•
Cancel the current job. Press Menu> or <Menu. The JOB MENU displays. Press
Menu> or <Menu until Cancel Job appears on the second line of the operator panel
display. Press Select.
•
Reset the printer. Press Menu> or <Menu. The JOB MENU displays. Press Menu>
or <Menu until Reset Printer appears on the second line of the operator panel
display. Press Select.
Note: Resetting the printer deletes all current data from the print buffer, including all
37 Insufficient
Defrag Memory
The printer memory used to store undeleted flash resources is too full to perform the
flash memory defragment operation.
•
Press Go to clear the message.
To perform the defragment operation, you can:
•
•
Delete fonts, macros, and other data in printer RAM.
Install additional printer memory.
37 Insufficient
Memory
The printer memory contains Print and Hold jobs, and is too full to continue processing
the current job.
Note: The messages, 37 Insufficient Memory and Held Jobs may be lost. Go/Stop?,
display alternately on the operator panel until you do one of the following:
Held Jobs may be
lost.
Go/Stop?
•
Press Go to clear the messages and continue printing the current job. The printer
frees memory by deleting all Print and Hold jobs. If the current job is a Print and
Hold job, it is not deleted.
•
•
Press Stop to clear the messages and continue printing the job. However, some
data may not print or may not print correctly.
Cancel the current job. Press Menu> or <Menu. The JOB MENU displays. Press
Menu> or <Menu until Cancel Job appears on the second line of the operator panel
display. Press Select.
•
Reset the printer. Press Menu> or <Menu. The JOB MENU displays. Press Menu>
or <Menu until Reset Printer appears on the second line of the operator panel
display. Press Select.
Note: Resetting the printer deletes all current data from the print buffer, including all
Chapter 6: Understanding Printer Messages
160
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Attendance Message
38 Memory Full
Meaning and Required Action
The printer is processing data, but the memory used to store pages is full.
•
Press Go to clear the message and continue printing the job. However, some data
may not print or may not print correctly.
•
Cancel the current job. Press Menu> or <Menu. The JOB MENU displays. Press
Menu> or <Menu until Cancel Job appears on the second line of the operator panel
display. Press Select.
•
Reset the printer. Press Menu> or <Menu. The JOB MENU displays. Press Menu>
or <Menu until Reset Printer appears on the second line of the operator panel
display. Press Select.
Note: Resetting the printer deletes all current data from the print buffer, including all
After resetting the printer, reduce the complexity of the print job and send it to print
again. To simplify the print job:
•
•
•
Reduce the amount of text or graphics on a page.
Reduce the print resolution.
Delete unnecessary downloaded fonts or macros.
Install additional printer memory to avoid future 38 Memory Full errors.
39 Complex Page
The page may not print correctly because the amount of text, graphics, or print infor-
mation on the page is very complex.
•
•
Set Page Protect in the SETUP MENU to On and send the print job again.
Press Go to clear the message and continue printing the job. However, some data
may not print or may not print correctly. Try to simplify the print job.
Cancel the current job. Press Menu> or <Menu. The JOB MENU displays. Press
Menu> or <Menu until Cancel Job appears on the second line of the operator panel
display. Press Select.
Reset the printer. Press Menu> or <Menu. The JOB MENU displays. Press Menu>
or <Menu until Reset Printer appears on the second line of the operator panel
display. Press Select.
•
•
Note: Resetting the printer deletes all current data from the print buffer, including all
51 Defective
Flash
The printer detects a defective flash memory option. This message appears when you
power On (|) the printer, or during format and write to flash operations.
Press Go to clear the message and continue printing. You must install a different flash
memory option before you can perform any flash memory operations.
Attendance Messages
161
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Attendance Message
52 Flash Full
Meaning and Required Action
There is not enough free space in the flash memory option to store the data that was
sent.
•
Press Go to clear the message and continue printing. Downloaded fonts and
macros not previously stored in flash memory are deleted.
Cancel the current job. Press Menu> or <Menu. The JOB MENU displays. Press
Menu> or <Menu until Cancel Job appears on the second line of the operator panel
display. Press Select.
•
•
Reset the printer. Press Menu> or <Menu. The JOB MENU displays. Press Menu>
or <Menu until Reset Printer appears on the second line of the operator panel
display. Press Select.
Note: Resetting the printer deletes all current data from the print buffer, including all
53 Unformatted
Flash
The printer detects an unformatted flash memory option. This message appears when
you power On (|) the printer.
You must format the flash memory option before you can perform any flash memory
operations. To format the flash memory option, select Format Flash from the
UTILITIES MENU.
Press Go to clear the message and continue printing. If the error message remains,
the flash memory option may be defective and need replacing.
Chapter 6: Understanding Printer Messages
162
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Attendance Message
Meaning and Required Action
54 Serial
Option 1 Error
A serial interface error is detected (framing or parity) on the optional serial port. This
error usually indicates the serial link has not been set up correctly. When the serial
error displays, the reporting of other serial errors is suppressed until interface
parameters are changed or the printer is reset.
54 Std Par ENA
Connection Lost
Displays only during the printer power-on cycle to indicate the connection to an
external print server (also called an external network adapter or ENA) is lost.
54 Par 1 ENA
Connection Lost
54 Ser 1 Fax
Connection Lost
The serial port is configured to receive fax data, but the connection to the external
modem has been lost. If the Fax Port menu item in the FAX MENU is not set to
Disabled, the printer automatically assumes a modem is connected for fax processing.
Check the interface to:
•
•
Verify you are using the correct cable.
Make sure the serial interface parameters (protocol, baud, parity, data bits) are
correct.
If one of these messages display:
•
Press Go to clear the message and continue printing the job. However, some data
may not print or may not print correctly.
•
Reset the printer. Press Menu> or <Menu. The JOB MENU displays. Press Menu>
or <Menu until Reset Printer appears on the second line of the operator panel
display. Press Select.
54 Network 1
Software Error
A network port is installed, but the software cannot establish communications with the
port.
•
Press Go to clear the message. The printer disables communications with the
network.
Note: Resetting the printer deletes all current data from the print buffer, including all
Attendance Messages
163
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Attendance Message
Meaning and Required Action
55 Insufficient
Fax Buffer
The printer link buffer used to process data is too full to receive an incoming fax.
This message usually displays when the printer is busy receiving, processing, or
printing data from a host interface connection while fax data is being received through
a serial interface port configured for fax processing.
•
Press Go to clear the message and continue printing the job. However, some data
may not print or may not print correctly.
•
Reset the printer. Press Menu> or <Menu. The JOB MENU displays. Press Menu>
or <Menu until Reset Printer appears on the second line of the operator panel
display. Press Select.
Note: Resetting the printer deletes all current data from the print buffer, including all
After this message displays, the connection between the printer and the sending fax
machine is broken. The printer will not accept additional fax data until sufficient fax
buffer space is made available. However, any fax data stored in the fax buffer is
56 Serial
Port 1 Disabled
Data is sent to the printer across the serial port, but the serial port is disabled. When
the serial error displays, the reporting of other serial errors is suppressed until the
menus are entered or the printer is reset.
If this message displays:
•
•
Make sure the Serial Buffer menu item in the SERIAL MENU is not set to Disabled.
Press Go to clear the message. The printer discards any data received on the serial
port.
•
Reset the printer. Press Menu> or <Menu. The JOB MENU displays. Press Menu>
or <Menu until Reset Printer appears on the second line of the operator panel
display. Press Select.
Note: Resetting the printer deletes all current data from the print buffer, including all
56 Std Parallel
Port Disabled
Data is sent to the printer through the parallel port, but the parallel port is disabled.
When the error displays, the reporting of other errors is suppressed until the menus
are entered or the printer is reset.
56 Parallel
Port 1 Disabled
If one of these messages displays:
•
•
•
Make sure the Parallel Buffer menu item in the PARALLEL MENU is not set to
Disabled.
Press Go to clear the message. The printer discards any data received through the
parallel port.
Reset the printer. Press Menu> or <Menu. The JOB MENU displays. Press Menu>
or <Menu until Reset Printer appears on the second line of the operator panel
display. Press Select.
Note: Resetting the printer deletes all current data from the print buffer, including all
Chapter 6: Understanding Printer Messages
164
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Attendance Message
Meaning and Required Action
58 Too Many
Flash Options
The printer detects more than one flash option installed. Your printer can only have
one flash option installed.
•
•
Press Go to clear the error.
Turn the printer power Off (O). Remove the extra option. Turn the printer power
61 Defective
Disk
The printer detects a defective hard disk option. This message appears when you
power On (|) the printer, or during hard disk format or write operations.
Press Go to clear the message and continue printing. You must install a different hard
disk option before you can perform any hard disk operations.
62 Disk Full
There is not enough free space in the hard disk option to store the data that was sent.
•
Press Go to clear the message and continue processing. Any information not
previously stored in the hard disk option is deleted.
•
Reset the printer. Press Menu> or <Menu. The JOB MENU displays. Press Menu>
or <Menu until Reset Printer appears on the second line of the operator panel
display. Press Select.
Note: Resetting the printer deletes all current data from the print buffer, including all
63 Unformatted
Disk
The printer detects an unformatted hard disk option. This message appears when you
power On (|) the printer.
You must format the hard disk option before you can perform any hard disk operations.
To format the hard disk option, select Format Disk from the UTILITIES MENU.
Press Go to clear the message and continue printing. If the error message remains,
the hard disk option may be defective and need replacing. Hard disk operations are
not allowed until the defective disk is replaced and the new one is formatted.
70 - 79 messages
Reserved for messages relating to the optional internal print server.
For more information, refer to the online documentation that comes with your printer.
Also, refer to the documentation that comes with the optional internal print server.
200 Paper Jam
Remove Cartridge
The printer detects a paper jam. Open the upper front door, remove the print cartridge,
and gently remove the jammed print material. Reinstall the print cartridge and close
for more information.
Press Go to clear the message and continue printing. The printer prints a new copy of
the page that jammed if Jam Recovery is set to On or Auto. However, the Auto setting
does not guarantee the page will print.
201 Paper Jam
Remove Cartridge
The printer detects a paper jam. Open the upper front door, remove the print cartridge,
and gently remove the jammed print material. Reinstall the print cartridge and close
for more information.
Press Go to clear the message and continue printing. The printer prints a new copy of
the page that jammed if Jam Recovery is set to On or Auto. However, the Auto setting
does not guarantee the page will print.
Attendance Messages
165
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Attendance Message
Meaning and Required Action
202 Paper Jam
Open Rear Door
The printer detects a paper jam behind the rear output bin door. Open the rear output
bin door and gently remove the jammed print material. Close the rear output bin door.
Press Go to clear the message and continue printing. The printer prints a new copy of
the page that jammed if Jam Recovery is set to On or Auto. However, the Auto setting
does not guarantee the page will print.
Once the print job is complete, close the rear output bin door.
203 Paper Jam
Short Paper
The printer detects a paper jam behind the rear output bin door. Open the rear output
bin door and gently remove the jammed print material. Leave the rear output bin door
Press Go to clear the message and continue printing. The printer prints a new copy of
the page that jammed if Jam Recovery is set to On or Auto. However, the Auto setting
does not guarantee the page will print.
Once the print job is complete, close the rear output bin door.
250 Paper Jam
Check MP Feeder
The printer detects a paper jam in the multipurpose feeder. If the print material is
visible from the front of the multipurpose feeder, pull it out gently. If only a small portion
is visible, open the upper front door, remove the print cartridge, and remove the
Press Go to clear the message and continue printing. The printer prints a new copy of
the page that jammed if Jam Recovery is set to On or Auto. However, the Auto setting
does not guarantee the page will print.
900-999 service
messages
These service messages indicate printer failures that may require service.
When a service message occurs, the printer immediately stops printing. Turn the
printer power Off (O), wait for about 10 seconds, and then turn the printer power
On (|).
If the service message recurs, call for service and report the message number and
description of the problem.
Chapter 6: Understanding Printer Messages
166
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Attendance Message
Change <input source>
Meaning and Required Action
The printer requests a different print material than what is loaded in the tray or set in
the PAPER SIZE or PAPER TYPE menus.
<Custom Type Name>
<size>
Line 1 displays the input source (<input source>), which is one of the following items:
<type><size>
•
•
•
Tray 1
Tray 2
MP Feeder
Note: Tray 2 only displays if the optional 500-sheet drawer is installed.
Line 2 displays one of the following items:
•
<Custom Type Name>: A user-defined name for Custom Type 1 through 6. The
name is truncated to fit on the operator panel display. Use the MarkVision utility to
information.
•
•
<size>: If the requested type matches the type currently in the paper source and the
custom type name has not been defined by you, only the print material or envelope
size (<size>) displays. The name is truncated to fit on the operator panel display.
<type><size>: The requested type (<type>) is a type other than a custom type. The
requested size (<size>) of print material or envelope displays. The type and size
names are truncated to fit on the operator panel display.
If you are using Tray 1 or Tray 2 when this message displays, you can:
•
•
•
Load the requested size and type print material in the input source. Press Go to
continue printing.
Press Select to clear the message and continue printing on the print material
installed in the input source.
Cancel the current job. Press Menu> or <Menu. The JOB MENU displays. Press
Menu> or <Menu until Cancel Job appears on the second line of the operator panel
display. Press Select.
•
Reset the printer. Press Menu> or <Menu. The JOB MENU displays. Press Menu>
or <Menu until Reset Printer appears on the second line of the operator panel
display. Press Select.
If you are using the multipurpose feeder when this message displays, you can:
•
Load the requested size and type print material in the multipurpose feeder. The
printer will clear the message and automatically continue printing.
If the correct print material is already loaded in the multipurpose feeder, press Go.
Cancel the current job. Press Menu> or <Menu. The JOB MENU displays. Press
Menu> or <Menu until Cancel Job appears on the second line of the operator panel
display. Press Select.
•
•
•
Reset the printer. Press Menu> or <Menu. The JOB MENU displays. Press Menu>
or <Menu until Reset Printer appears on the second line of the operator panel
display. Press Select.
Note: Resetting the printer deletes all current data from the print buffer, including all
Attendance Messages
167
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Attendance Message
Meaning and Required Action
Check Tray 2
Connection
The printer has lost communication with the optional 500-sheet drawer.
Communication may be lost if the optional 500-sheet drawer was removed from the
printer, for example, to clear a paper jam. The optional 500-sheet drawer may still be
attached to the printer, but may not be fully connected or may be experiencing a
hardware failure.
Note: This message only displays if the optional 500-sheet drawer is installed.
If this message displays:
•
•
Reestablish communication by removing the optional 500-sheet drawer and
more information. When the optional 500-sheet drawer is recognized by the printer,
the message clears.
In case of a hardware failure, turn the printer power Off (O) and back On (|). If the
error recurs, turn the printer power Off (O), remove the optional 500-sheet drawer,
and call for service.
Close Door or
Insert Cartridge
The upper front door is open or the print cartridge is not installed.
Close the door or install the print cartridge, then close the door.
Delete All Jobs.
Go/Stop?
The printer requests confirmation to delete all Print and Hold jobs. This message
displays if Delete All Jobs is selected from the CONFIDENTIAL JOB menu item or
from the HELD JOBS menu item.
•
•
Press Go to continue. The printer deletes all Print and Hold jobs.
Press Stop to cancel this operation.
Enter PIN:
=____
The printer requests you enter a four-digit Personal Identification Number (PIN)
associated with your Confidential Job once you enter the CONFIDENTIAL JOB menu
item on the operator panel. You use the operator panel buttons to enter the number.
mation.
Files will be
Lost. Go/Stop?
This message displays when you change the Job Buffer Size setting on the operator
panel. The printer must reformat the hard disk option. The message asks for confir-
mation to continue and erase all files on the hard disk option.
•
Press Go to continue. The hard disk option formats and the specified job buffer
partition is created. The message Format Disk displays while the hard disk option
formats.
•
Press Stop to cancel this operation.
Chapter 6: Understanding Printer Messages
168
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Attendance Message
Insert Tray 1
Meaning and Required Action
This message displays when the printer needs to select print material from Tray 1
(250-sheet input tray). The printer is requesting the 250-sheet input tray be inserted so
it can continue printing. This may happen if you remove the 250-sheet input tray to fill
it with print material while a job is printing.
Note: This message only displays for Tray 1 if the optional 500-sheet drawer is
installed. If the optional 500-sheet drawer is not installed and Tray 1 is removed from
the printer after a job is sent to print, a Load <input source> message displays
To avoid this message, press Stop, wait for the job to stop printing, and then remove
the 250-sheet input tray to fill it.
When this message occurs:
•
•
Insert Tray 1 to clear the message and continue printing the job.
Cancel the current job. Press Menu> or <Menu. The JOB MENU displays. Press
Menu> or <Menu until Cancel Job appears on the second line of the operator panel
display. Press Select.
•
Reset the printer. Press Menu> or <Menu. The JOB MENU displays. Press Menu>
or <Menu until Reset Printer appears on the second line of the operator panel
display. Press Select.
Note: Resetting the printer deletes all current data from the print buffer, including all
Install Tray 2
or Cancel Job
The printer has lost communication with the optional 500-sheet drawer support unit.
The support unit is not properly attached to the printer when you have sent a job to
print.
When this message occurs:
•
Reattach the printer to the optional 500-sheet drawer support unit to clear the
message and continue printing the job.
1 Lift the printer by the handholds or ask someone to help you lift the printer. Make
sure your fingers are not under the printer when you set it down.
2 Place the printer on top of the support unit. Make sure the edges of the printer
and the support unit are aligned properly.
•
•
Cancel the current job. Press Menu> or <Menu. The JOB MENU displays. Press
Menu> or <Menu until Cancel Job appears on the second line of the operator panel
display. Press Select.
Reset the printer. Press Menu> or <Menu. The JOB MENU displays. Press Menu>
or <Menu until Reset Printer appears on the second line of the operator panel
display. Press Select.
Note: Resetting the printer deletes all current data from the print buffer, including all
Attendance Messages
169
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Attendance Message
Load <input source>
Meaning and Required Action
The printer is trying to feed print material from an input source it detects is empty.
<Custom Type Name>
<size>
<type><size>
Line 1 displays the input source (<input source>), which is one of the following items:
•
•
•
Tray 1
Tray 2
MP Feeder
Note: Tray 2 only displays if the optional 500-sheet drawer is installed.
Line 2 displays one of the following items:
•
<Custom Type Name>: A user-defined name for custom type 1 through 6. The
name is truncated to fit on the operator panel display. Use the MarkVision utility to
information.
•
•
<size>: If the requested type matches the type currently in the tray and the custom
type name has not been defined by you, only the print material or envelope size
displays. The name is truncated to fit on the operator panel display.
<type><size>: The requested type (<type>) is a type other than a custom type. The
requested size <size> of print material or envelope displays. The type and size
names are truncated to fit on the operator panel display.
If you are using Tray 1 or Tray 2 when this message displays, you can:
•
Load the requested size and type print material in the input source. Press Go to
continue printing.
•
Cancel the current job. Press Menu> or <Menu. The JOB MENU displays. Press
Menu> or <Menu until Cancel Job appears on the second line of the operator panel
display. Press Select.
•
Reset the printer. Press Menu> or <Menu. The JOB MENU displays. Press Menu>
or <Menu until Reset Printer appears on the second line of the operator panel
display. Press Select.
If you are using the multipurpose feeder when this message displays, you can:
•
Load the requested size and type print material in the multipurpose feeder. The
printer will clear the message and automatically continue printing.
If the correct print material is already loaded in the multipurpose feeder, press Go.
Cancel the current job. Press Menu> or <Menu. The JOB MENU displays. Press
Menu> or <Menu until Cancel Job appears on the second line of the operator panel
display. Press Select.
•
•
•
Reset the printer. Press Menu> or <Menu. The JOB MENU displays. Press Menu>
or <Menu until Reset Printer appears on the second line of the operator panel
display. Press Select.
Note: Resetting the printer deletes all current data from the print buffer, including all
Chapter 6: Understanding Printer Messages
170
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Attendance Message
Load Manual
Meaning and Required Action
The printer requests print material to be manually fed from the multipurpose feeder.
Line 2 displays one of the following items:
<Custom Type Name>
<size>
<type><size>
•
<Custom Type Name>: A user-defined name for custom type 1 through 6. The
name is truncated to fit on the operator panel display. Use the MarkVision utility to
information.
•
•
<size>: If the requested type matches the type currently in the tray and the custom
type name has not been defined by you, only the print material or envelope size
displays. The name is truncated to fit on the operator panel display.
<type><size>: The requested type (<type>) is a type other than a custom type. The
requested size (<size>) of print material or envelope displays. The type and size
names are truncated to fit on the operator panel display.
When this message displays you can:
•
•
•
•
Load the requested size or type of print material in the multipurpose feeder. The
printer automatically clears the message and continues printing.
Press Go if the correct size and type print material is loaded in the multipurpose
feeder.
Press Select to clear the message and print on the print material installed in Tray 1
or the optional Tray 2.
Cancel the current job. Press Menu> or <Menu. The JOB MENU displays. Press
Menu> or <Menu until Cancel Job appears on the second line of the operator panel
display. Press Select.
•
Reset the printer. Press Menu> or <Menu. The JOB MENU displays. Press Menu>
or <Menu until Reset Printer appears on the second line of the operator panel
display. Press Select.
Note: Resetting the printer deletes all current data from the print buffer, including all
No Jobs Found.
Retry?
The Personal Identification Number (PIN) you entered is not a PIN associated with any
Confidential Job in printer memory.
•
•
Press Go to enter another PIN.
Press Stop to exit the PIN entry prompt.
mation.
Attendance Messages
171
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Attendance Message
Open Rear Door
Meaning and Required Action
The print material in the multipurpose feeder is 152.4 mm (6 in.) or less in length and
the rear output bin door is not open.
When this message displays you can:
•
•
Open the rear output bin door to let the print material exit.
Cancel the current job. Press Menu> or <Menu. The JOB MENU displays. Press
Menu> or <Menu until Cancel Job appears on the second line of the operator panel
display. Press Select.
•
Reset the printer. Press Menu> or <Menu. The JOB MENU displays. Press Menu>
or <Menu until Reset Printer appears on the second line of the operator panel
display. Press Select.
Note: Resetting the printer deletes all current data from the print buffer, including all
Operation Failed
Jobs on Disk
This message displays when the printer receives a request to format the hard disk
option or modify the Job Buffer Size setting and Print and Hold jobs are currently
stored on the hard disk option.
Operation Failed
Faxes on Disk
This message displays when the printer receives a request to format the hard disk
option or modify the Job Buffer Size setting and fax jobs are currently stored on the
hard disk option.
You cannot format the hard disk option or change the Job Buffer Size while the hard
disk option contains Print and Hold jobs or fax jobs.
•
Press Go to continue. The request is ignored.
Print Jobs on
Disk? Go/Stop?
This message displays when Print Job Buffering is enabled and the printer power is
turned Off (O) while print jobs are spooled to the hard disk option. When the printer
power is turned back On (|), it asks for confirmation to print the waiting jobs.
•
•
Press Go to print the jobs.
Press Return or Stop to delete all spooled jobs from the hard disk option without
printing them.
Chapter 6: Understanding Printer Messages
172
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Solving Printer
Problems
7
Sometimes printer problems are very easy to solve. When
you have a problem, first make sure that:
•
The printer power cord is plugged into the printer
and a properly grounded electrical outlet.
Note: If an error message dis-
•
•
The printer power switch is On (| ).
The electrical outlet is not turned off by any switch
or breaker.
•
•
Other electrical equipment plugged into the outlet
is working.
All options are properly installed.
If you have checked all of the above and still have a prob-
lem, turn the printer power Off (O), wait for about 10 sec-
onds, and then turn the printer power On (| ). This often
fixes the problem.
Solving Printer Problems
173
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
The tables in this chapter define printing problems that
may occur and what you can do to resolve them. If the
suggested corrective action does not fix the problem, call
your service representative.
Turn to the appropriate page for help with your printing
problem:
Problem with...
Display
See page...
Print Quality
Printing
Network
Option
Other Problems and Questions
Chapter 7: Solving Printer Problems
174
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Display Problems
Problem
Action
Menus Disabled status message
The operator panel menus are disabled. To enable the menus:
appears on the display.
•
•
•
Turn the printer power Off (O).
Press and hold Select and Return, and then turn the printer power On (|).
Release the buttons when Performing Self Test displays.
Once the printer finishes powering on, the CONFIG MENU displays.
•
•
Press Menu> until Panel Menus displays on the second line. Press Select.
Press Menu> until Enable displays on the second line. Press Select.
The Saved message briefly appears and then, the Enabling Menus displays.
The CONFIG MENU displays again with Panel Menu on the second line.
•
Press Menu> until Exit Config Menu displays on the second line. Press
Select.
Activating Menu Changes briefly appears, and then Performing Self Test
briefly appears. The printer returns to the Ready state.
If the operator panel menus are password protected, see your system adminis-
trator.
Display shows only diamonds or is
blank.
•
•
Turn the printer power Off (O), wait about 10 seconds, and turn the printer
power On (|).
The Performing Self Test message appears on the operator panel display.
When the test is completed, the Ready message displays.
If the messages do not display, turn the printer power Off (O) and call Lexmark
Customer Support Center.
Menu settings changed from the
operator panel have no effect.
Settings in the software application, the printer driver, or the printer utilities are
overriding the settings in the operator panel.
•
Change the menu settings from the printer driver, the printer utilities, or the
software application instead of the operator panel.
•
Disable the settings in the printer driver, the printer utilities, or the software
application so you can change settings from the operator panel.
Display Problems
175
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Printing Problems
Problem
Action
Job did not print or incorrect
characters printed.
Make sure the Ready status message appears on the operator panel display
before you send a job to print. Press Go to return the printer to the Ready status
message.
Make sure there is print material loaded in the printer. Press Go to return the
printer to the Ready status message.
Verify that the printer is using the correct printer language.
•
•
Verify that the correct printer driver is being used.
Make sure the parallel cable or USB cable is firmly plugged in at the back of
the printer.
•
Check the cable connection. Make sure you are using the correct cable. If
you use the parallel port, we recommend a IEEE 1284-compliant parallel
cable such as Lexmark part number 1329605 (10 ft) or 1427498 (20 ft). If
you use the USB port, we recommend the cable with Lexmark part number
12A2405 (2M).
•
•
If the printer is connected through a switch box, try a direct connection.
Verify that the correct paper size is selected through the operator panel, in
the printer driver, or in the software application setting.
Make sure PCL SmartSwitch and PS SmartSwitch are set to On.
If a print spooler is used, verify that the spooler is not stalled.
•
•
•
Determine which host interface you are using. Print a menu settings page to
If you are using serial interface:
•
•
Make sure Honor DSR is set to Off.
Check the protocol, baud, parity, and data bit settings. The settings on the
printer and on the host computer should match.
You are connected to the USB
port, but the printer will not print.
Make sure you are using Windows 98 or other USB-capable operating system
supported by Lexmark.
Chapter 7: Solving Printer Problems
176
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Problem (continued)
Action (continued)
Print material misfeeds or multiple
feeds occur.
•
Make sure the print material you are using meets the specifications for your
Flex print material before loading it in any of the paper sources.
Make sure the print material is loaded correctly.
Make sure the paper width and length guides on the paper sources are
adjusted correctly and are not too tight.
•
•
•
•
•
Do not overfill the paper sources.
Do not force print material into the multipurpose feeder when you load it;
otherwise, it may skew or buckle.
•
•
Remove any curled print material from paper sources.
If there is a recommended print side for the print material, load the print
Load less print material in the input sources.
Turn the print material over or around and try printing again to see if feeding
improves.
•
•
•
•
•
Do not mix print material types.
Do not mix reams of print material.
Remove the top and bottom sheets of a ream before loading the print
material.
•
Load an input source only when it is empty.
You get unexpected page breaks. Check the Print Timeout setting in the SETUP MENU. Increase the setting. See
Job prints from the wrong input
source or on the wrong print
material.
Check the PAPER TYPE setting in the PAPER MENU on the operator panel and
Print material does not stack
neatly in an output bin.
•
•
Turn the print material stack over in the tray or multipurpose feeder.
If the print material is exiting to the standard output bin, make sure the paper
information.
Printing Problems
177
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Print Quality
Problems
Problem
Action
Print is too light.
•
•
Check the toner supply.
Change the Toner Darkness setting in the QUALITY MENU. See Toner
•
If you are printing on an uneven print surface, change the PAPER WEIGHT
and PAPER TEXTURE settings in the PAPER MENU. See PAPER TYPE on
page 47 for more information.
•
•
Verify that the correct print material is being used.
Toner smears or print comes off
the page.
If you are printing on an uneven print surface, change the PAPER TEXTURE
and PAPER WEIGHT settings in the PAPER MENU. See PAPER TEXTURE on
•
•
If the problem continues, call Lexmark Customer Support Center.
Toner appears on the back of the
printed page.
Toner is on the transfer roll. To help prevent this, do not load print material that
is smaller than the page size of the job to be printed.
•
Open and close the printer upper front door to run the printer through its
setup cycle and clean the transfer roll.
•
Replace the fuser cleaner. The fuser cleaner and replacement instructions
are included in the box when you purchase a new print cartridge.
Toner fog or background shading
appears on the page.
•
•
•
more information.
Entire page is white.
•
•
•
Make sure the packaging material is removed from the print cartridge. See
Check the toner supply.
Chapter 7: Solving Printer Problems
178
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Problem (continued)
Action (continued)
Streaks appear on the page.
•
The toner may be low. Remove the cartridge. To utilize the remaining toner,
•
•
If you are using preprinted forms, make sure the ink can withstand
temperatures of 200°C (392°F).
on page 195 for directions.
Printing is too dark.
Change the Toner Darkness setting in the QUALITY MENU. See Toner
Note: Macintosh users should make sure the lines per inch (lpi) setting is not
set too high in the software application.
Characters have jagged or uneven
edges.
•
•
•
Change the Print Resolution setting in the QUALITY MENU to 600 dpi. See
information.
If you are using downloaded fonts, verify that the fonts are supported by the
printer, the host computer, and the software application.
Image quality is poor.
Resolution was automatically reduced. Reduce the complexity of the print job
information.
Part of all of the page is printed in
black.
•
•
If the charge roll has been replaced, verify that it has been installed correctly.
Refer to the installation instructions that come with the charge roll kit. See
The job prints, but the left and top
margins are incorrect.
•
•
•
Make sure the PAPER SIZE setting is set correctly in the PAPER MENU. See
Make sure the margins are set correctly in the software application you are
using.
Check the Print Area setting in the SETUP MENU. Set the value to Normal.
Print Quality Problems
179
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Option Problems
Problem
Action
Option does not operate correctly
after it is installed or it quits
working.
•
•
•
Turn the printer power Off (O), wait for about 10 seconds, and turn the printer
power On (|). If this does not fix the problem, unplug the printer, and check
the connection between the option and printer.
Print the menu settings page and check to see if the option is listed in the
Make sure the option is selected in the software application you are using.
For Macintosh users: Make sure the printer is set up in CHOOSER.
Option does not operate correctly Optional Drawer: Make sure the connection between the optional 500-sheet
after it is installed.
page 223 for more information.
page 124 for more information.
Flash Memory Option: Check to make sure the flash memory option is
Printer Memory Option: Check to make sure the printer memory option is
Hard Disk Option: Check to make sure the hard disk option is securely
more information.
Hard Disk Adapter Card: Check to make sure the hard disk option is securely
connected to the hard disk adapter card. Also check to make sure the hard disk
Internal Print Server Option: Check to make sure the optional internal print
server (also called an internal network adapter or INA) is securely connected to
The connection to the network is made through the network cable. Check that
you have the correct cable, that it is securely connected, and that the network
software is correctly set up. See the documentation that comes with your
optional internal print server for more information.
Tri-Port Interface Option: Check to make sure the Tri-Port Interface option
For Macintosh users: Make sure the host computer is set to LocalTalk.
If you are using a phone wire connection, a terminator plug must be used.
Chapter 7: Solving Printer Problems
180
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Problem (continued)
Action (continued)
Option does not operate correctly Infrared Adapter: If infrared communication stops or does not occur, check the
after it is installed.
(continued)
following:
•
Communication distance: The distance between the two infrared ports
should be 3 meters (10 ft.) or less. If communication does not occur between
ports, move the ports closer together.
•
•
Make sure both ports are stable. Make sure the computer is on a level
surface.
Make sure the angle of communication between the two infrared ports is
within 15 degrees of either side of an imaginary line drawn between the two
infrared ports.
•
•
Make sure there is no bright light, such as direct sunshine, interfering with
communication.
Make sure no objects are placed between the two infrared ports.
Parallel/USB Interface Option: Check to make sure the parallel/USB interface
option card is securely connected to the printer system board. See
Network Printing
Problems
Problem
Action
Job did not print or incorrect
characters printed.
If you are using a Lexmark internal print server or external print server, verify
that it is set up properly and the network cable is connected.
Note: Refer to the documentation that comes with your print server for more
information.
For Novell users:
•
•
Make sure the netware.drv file is dated October 24, 1994 or later.
Make sure the NT (no tabs) flag is included in the capture statement.
For Macintosh users:
•
The printer may need an optional internal print server to allow Macintosh
connection.
•
Verify that the printer is set up correctly in CHOOSER.
Network Printing Problems
181
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Other Problems
and Questions
Problem
Action
How do I get updated printer
drivers or utilities?
How do I attach a serial cable to
the printer?
Your printer requires an optional adapter to allow serial attachment. The Tri-Port
Where are the printer escape
codes listed?
The CD that was shipped with your printer contains an Adobe Acrobat file with
a complete list of Printer Command Language (PCL) escape codes.
Chapter 7: Solving Printer Problems
182
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Clearing Jams
8
By carefully selecting print materials and loading them
properly, you should be able to avoid most paper jams. If
paper jams do occur, complete the steps in the following
sections. If paper jams occur frequently, make sure you see
To clear paper jam attendance messages, you must remove
all jammed print material from the paper path.
Press Go to resume printing. If Jam Recovery is set to On or
Auto, the printer prints a new copy of the page that
jammed. However, the Auto setting does not guarantee the
page will print.
Refer to the appropriate page for help with clearing paper
jams.
If the following error message displays...
200 Paper Jam - Remove Print Cartridge
201 Paper Jam - Remove Print Cartridge
202 Paper Jam - Open Rear Door
See page...
203 Paper Jam - Short Paper
250 Paper Jam - Check MP Feeder
Clearing Jams
183
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Possible Paper The following illustration shows the path that print mate-
rial travels through the printer. The path varies depending
on the input source and exit selection (output bin). The
jam areas are also shown.
Jam Areas
203 Paper Jam
201 Paper Jam
200 Paper Jam
202 Paper Jam
250 Paper Jam
200 and 201 Paper
Jam - Remove
Cartridge
Print material is jammed in the area under the print
cartridge. This requires removing the print cartridge from
the printer. With a 201 attendance message, the jam is far-
ther back in the printer, so you need to reach in farther to
remove the jammed print material.
Note: To clear paper jam
attendance messages, you must
remove all jammed print material
from the paper path.
1 Open the upper front door.
2 Remove the print cartridge.
cartridge.
Caution! The rear portion of
the inside of the printer may be
hot.
Chapter 8: Clearing Jams
184
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
3 Notice that in some instances the ends of the print
material are not visible.
4 Gently pull the right side of the print material
until the upper right corner is loose.
5 With both hands, pull the print material up to the
right and then out.
instructions on reinstalling the print cartridge.)
7 Close the upper front door.
Note: If there is resistance to
the print material, and it does
not move immediately when you
pull it, stop pulling and access
the print material from the rear
page 186 for more information.
Possible Paper Jam Areas
185
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
202 Paper Jam -
Open Rear Door
Jams in the following areas cause a 202 attendance mes-
sage. Jams in these areas require opening the printer rear
output bin door and the upper front door:
•
The print material jams before reaching the
•
The print material jams after it starts into the
standard output bin, but before it exits completely
Note: To clear paper jam
Before Reaching the Standard Output Bin
attendance messages, you must
remove all jammed print material
from the paper path.
The print material jams before reaching the standard
output bin.
1 Locate the handhold on the rear output bin door
and pull it toward you.
The rear output bin door opens and drops back
Chapter 8: Clearing Jams
186
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2 Determine how to remove the jammed print
material based on what part of the print material is
visible.
– If the middle of the sheet of print material is
visible, but not the ends, grasp the print material
on both sides and gently pull it straight out
toward you.
Note: If print material is still in
the fuser area, open the upper
front door to release the fuser
rollers to free the print material.
Possible Paper Jam Areas
187
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
– If an end of the print material is visible, pull the
print material straight out toward you.
Note: To avoid tearing, pull the
jammed print material out gently
and slowly.
3 Close the rear output bin door.
Chapter 8: Clearing Jams
188
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Note: To clear paper jam
attendance messages, you must
remove all jammed print material
from the paper path.
Exiting to the Standard Output Bin
Print material jams before it exits completely into the
standard output bin.
1 Pull the print material straight out. If there is resis-
tance to the print material and it does not move
immediately when you pull, stop pulling and con-
tinue with the next step.
2 Open the upper front door to release the fuser
rollers.
3 Pull the print material straight out.
Note: To avoid tearing, pull the
jammed print material out gently
and slowly.
Possible Paper Jam Areas
189
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
203 Paper Jam -
Short Paper
A 203 attendance message indicates print material less
than 152.4 mm (6 in.) in length has attempted to exit the
standard output bin.
A jam in this area requires that the rear output bin door be
opened.
Note: To clear paper jam
attendance messages, you must
remove all jammed print material
from the paper path.
1 Locate the handhold on the rear output bin door
and pull it toward you.
The rear output bin door opens and drops back
Chapter 8: Clearing Jams
190
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2 Remove the print material.
If there is resistance to the print material and it does
not move immediately when you pull, stop pulling.
Remove the print cartridge, return to the back of the
printer, and pull the print material out.
Note: If you cannot find the
jammed print material inside the
printer, check to see if the print
job has exited the standard out-
put bin.
3 Leave the rear output bin door open to allow the
job to finish printing.
4 Press Go to resume printing.
5 If you are going to print additional pages less than
152.4 mm (6 in.) in length, set Paper Length to Short.
Possible Paper Jam Areas
191
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
250 Paper Jam -
Check MP Feeder
The print material jams as it enters the printer from the
multipurpose feeder.
Pull the jammed print material straight out of the multi-
purpose feeder toward you.
To avoid tearing, pull the jammed print material out gen-
tly and slowly.
Note: To clear paper jam
attendance messages, you must
remove all jammed print material
from the paper path.
Chapter 8: Clearing Jams
192
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Maintaining
Your Printer
9
Note: If you are in the U.S. or
Canada, call 1-800-438-2468 for
information about Lexmark
Authorized Supplies Dealers in
your area. In other countries,
contact the place where you
bought your printer.
Periodically, you will need to replace the print cartridge
and clean the printer to maintain optimum print quality.
If several people are using the printer, you may want to
designate a key operator to do the setup and maintenance
of your printer. Refer printing problems and maintenance
tasks to this key operator.
Ordering a Print You need to have a new print cartridge available when the
current one no longer prints satisfactorily. There are two
recommended print cartridges specifically designed for
your printer:
Cartridge
Printer Model Part Number
Yield (Average) Coverage
Optra M410 or 17G0152
M412
5,000 pages
5%
Optra M410 or 17G0154
M412
15,000 pages
5%
Ordering a Print Cartridge
193
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Storing the Print Store the print cartridge in the original packaging until
you are ready to install it.
Cartridge
Do not store the print cartridge in:
•
•
Temperatures greater than 40°C (104°F).
An environment with extreme changes in humidity
or temperature.
•
•
•
•
•
Direct sunlight.
Dusty places.
A car for a long period of time.
An environment where corrosive gases are present.
An environment with salty air.
Replacing the Complete the following steps to replace the print
cartridge. Refer to the documentation that comes with the
print cartridge for detailed installation information.
Print Cartridge
Warning! Do not refill used
1 Remove the used print cartridge.
2 Clean the printer.
print cartridges or purchase a
refilled cartridge. The print car-
tridge warranty is voided by
unauthorized refilling.
3 Install the new print cartridge.
4 Replace the fuser cleaner.
Use the installation instructions that come in the
box with your new print cartridge to complete steps
5 Follow the instructions on the new print cartridge
box to recycle the used print cartridge.
When you return a used print cartridge, you contribute to
a worldwide recycling effort at no cost to you.
For best results, use Lexmark supplies with the printer.
Chapter 9: Maintaining Your Printer
194
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Cleaning the Complete the following steps to clean the printhead lens:
Printhead Lens
1 Turn the printer power Off (O).
2 Open the upper and lower front doors.
3 Remove the print cartridge.
4 Gently wipe the printhead lens with a clean, dry
lint-free cloth.
Printhead Lens
5 Insert the print cartridge.
6 Close the upper and lower front doors.
7 Turn the printer power On (| ).
Ordering a We recommend you order a new charge roll kit when
toner fog or background shading appears on printed
Charge Roll Kit
information on toner fog and background shading.
Order Lexmark part number 4K00196. Installation instruc-
tions are included in the kit.
If you’re in the U.S. or Canada, call 1-800-438-2468 for
information about Lexmark Authorized Supplies Dealers
in your area. In other countries, contact the place where
you bought your printer.
Cleaning the Printhead Lens
195
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Chapter 9: Maintaining Your Printer
196
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Fax
10
Understanding the If your printer has a Tri-Port interface option card
installed and the serial interface port is not in use, you can
Fax Port
use your printer to receive and print fax data.
The serial interface port is only available if a Tri-Port inter-
When you want to use the fax serial port for another pur-
pose, you must first follow the instructions for disabling
port, make sure you follow the instructions for setting up
Note: Never attempt to config-
ure your serial port for multiple
uses with an A-B switch.
Choosing To use your printer serial port to process fax data, you
need an external, class 1 fax modem. You can use virtually
any brand, as long as it is a class 1 fax modem.
Hardware
Understanding the Fax Port
197
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Setting Up a To use your printer serial port to process fax data:
Fax Port
1 Turn the printer power Off (O) and unplug the
printer power cord.
2 Turn the modem power Off and unplug the
Printer
modem power cord.
Serial
Port
Power Cord
3 Disconnect all cables from the back of the printer.
Modem
Cable
4 Connect the hardware. The end of the modem cable
that connects to the serial port must be 25-pin.
External
Class 1
Fax
Phone
Cord
The class 1 fax modem connects to the serial port of
your printer. If you need additional help, refer to the
class 1 fax modem documentation for details.
Modem
Note: It is very important to
power on the modem before you
power on the printer.
5 Reconnect all cables to the back of the printer.
6 Reconnect the power cords to the printer and the
modem to properly grounded electrical outlets.
7 Turn the modem power On.
8 Turn the printer power On (| ).
9 Once Ready displays, complete the following steps
to configure the serial port for fax data:
identify the display and operator
panel buttons if you need help.
a Press Menu> or <Menu to enter the menus.
b Press Menu> until FAX MENU appears on the first
line of the display.
c Press Select.
Fax Port appears on the second line of the display.
d Press Select to choose Fax Port.
Chapter 10: Fax
198
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Note: If an error message
e Press Menu> until Ser Option 1 appears on the
second line of the display.
f
Press Select to choose Ser Option 1.
g Fax Port appears on the second line. Press Go.
Activating Menu Changes appears and remains on
the display until the serial port is reset.
Resetting a If power to the modem is interrupted you must complete
the following steps, in order, for your printer to process fax
data:
Fax Port
1 Turn the printer power Off (O).
2 Turn the modem power On.
3 Turn the printer power On (| ).
Resetting a Fax Port
199
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Disabling a To disable the fax port and restore the printer serial port
settings:
Fax Port
1 When Ready displays on the top line of the opera-
tor panel display, press Menu> or <Menu to enter the
menus.
2 Continue to press Menu> or <Menu until FAX MENU
appears on the first line of the display.
3 Press Select.
Fax Port appears on the second line of the display.
4 Press Select to choose Fax Port.
5 Press Menu> until Disabled appears on the second
line of the display.
Serial Option 1 displays on the second line of the dis-
play.
6 Press Select to disable the fax port.
7 Press Go.
Activating Menu Changes appears and remains on the
display until the printer restores the serial port
settings.
Note: If an error message
8 Turn the modem power Off.
9 Turn the printer power Off (O).
10 Disconnect all system components from the
modem.
11 Disconnect the modem cable from the printer
serial port.
12 Turn the printer power On (| ).
Chapter 10: Fax
200
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Memory and
Option Cards
11
Note: You need a small Phil-
lips screwdriver to complete the
installation of some options.
You can customize your printer memory capacity and con-
nectivity. This chapter provides instructions for installing
and removing each option. To install each option, you
must first access the printer system board. This can be
done from the left side of the printer.
Accessing the Complete the following steps before installing printer
memory, a flash memory option, or an option card.
Printer System
Board
1 Turn the printer power Off (O) and unplug the
printer power cord from the electrical outlet.
Caution! To avoid electrical
2 Disconnect all cables from the back of the printer.
shock hazards, make sure your
computer power is Off (O) and
unplug all computer equipment
before connecting cables.
Accessing the Printer System Board
201
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
3 Push the upper release latch to release the upper
front door.
4 Push the lower release latch to release the lower
front door.
5 Press the latches located inside the front of the
printer to release the side door.
Chapter 11: Memory and Option Cards
202
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 Remove the side door and lay it aside.
7 Loosen the six screws on the shield. Do not
Screws
remove the screws.
Screws
Accessing the Printer System Board
203
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
8 Use the tabs located on the side of the shield to
slide the shield up until the top three screws fit
into the three keyholes on the shield.
Keyhole
9 Hold the shield by the tabs and lift it off.
Tabs
10 Locate the appropriate connector for the option
Memory
Connector 1
Memory
Connector 2
you are installing.
Option Card Connector
Note: Both memory connec-
tor 1 and memory connector 2
are capable of accepting either a
printer memory option or a flash
memory option card.
Chapter 11: Memory and Option Cards
204
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
11 See the appropriate section for instructions on
installing the option.
– For a printer memory or flash memory option,
– For an optional internal print server (also called
an internal network adapter or INA), see
– For a Parallel/ USB interface option card, see
Accessing the Printer System Board
205
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Understanding Because the steps required to install a printer memory
option and a flash memory option card are the same, they
are grouped together in this section. Details about the two
option cards follow.
Memory Options
Printer Memory
The printer memory option increases the printer sync
dynamic random access memory (SDRAM). Additional
printer memory allows the printer to print complex jobs
and operate more efficiently.
Your printer has 4MB of standard printer memory. You
can purchase printer memory cards having 4MB, 8MB,
16MB, 32MB, and 64MB of memory. You can install up to
two optional printer memory cards in your printer, for a
total of up to 132MB of SDRAM.
Warning! Data stored in printer
memory is lost when the printer
is unplugged.
Flash Memory
The flash memory option is useful for storing information
such as downloaded fonts, macros, symbol sets, logos,
and forms. Use your printer driver or the MarkVision
utility to download resources to flash memory.
You can install one flash memory option in your printer.
Flash memory options available are 2, 4, 8, and 16MB.
Note: Data stored in flash
memory is retained when the
printer is unplugged.
option, which provides memory storage similar to the
flash memory option.
Chapter 11: Memory and Option Cards
206
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Installing This section offers instructions for installing either a
printer memory option or a flash memory option card.
You may install any one of the following memory configu-
rations on your printer system board:
Memory Options
•
•
•
One printer memory option.
One flash memory option.
One printer memory option and one flash memory
option.
•
Two printer memory options.
Before installing any option card, you must remove the
printer system board cover.
Warning! Printer memory and
flash memory option cards are
easily damaged by static elec-
tricity. Touch something metal
before you touch an option card.
2 Locate the two memory connectors on the system
Memory Connector 1
Memory Connector 2
board.
Both memory connector 1 and memory connector 2
are capable of accepting either a printer memory
option or a flash memory option card.
remove an option card before you install a new
one. Otherwise, go to step 4.
Installing Memory Options
207
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
4 Unpack the new option card.
Connection Points
Avoid touching the connection points along the
edge of the card. Save the packaging.
Warning! Printer memory
option and flash memory option
cards are easily damaged by
static electricity. Touch some-
thing metal before you touch an
option card.
5 Hold the option card with the connection points
Connection Points
pointing toward the system board as shown.
Chapter 11: Memory and Option Cards
208
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6 Insert the option card straight into the connector
as shown.
Make sure the edges of the card fit into the slots
located on each of the connector latches.
Note: This illustration is for the
Optra M410. The connector for
the Optra M412 is inverted.
Invert the option card to insert it.
7 Push in on one side of the card and push in one of
the latches until it snaps into place. Repeat for the
other side of the card.
Latch
Make sure each latch fits over the notch located on
either side of the option card.
ory option card in one of the memory connectors.
Otherwise, go to step 9.
Notch
page 216 if you have other option cards to install.
Installing Memory Options
209
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Removing Before removing a memory option, follow the steps under
Memory Options
To remove a printer memory option or a flash memory
option card:
Warning! Printer memory
option and flash memory option
cards are easily damaged by
static electricity. Touch some-
thing metal before you touch an
option card.
1 Locate the option card that you want to remove.
2 Push the latches at each end of the memory con-
nector away from the option card.
3 Pull the option card straight out of the memory
connector.
4 Place the option card in its original packaging.
If you did not save the packaging, wrap the option
card in paper and store it in a box.
5 Follow the steps under “Installing Memory
printer memory option or flash memory option
Chapter 11: Memory and Option Cards
210
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Understanding Four kinds of option cards are available for your printer:
Option Cards
•
•
•
•
Internal print server option card
Tri-Port interface option card
Hard disk option
Parallel/ USB interface option card
Refer to the documentation that is included with each
option card for detailed information about that specific
card.
Note: Only one option card
can be installed in your printer at
a time.
The installation instructions are the same for each type of
option card; therefore, they are grouped together. Installa-
Internal Print Server
(Internal Network
Adapter or INA)
An optional internal print server lets you connect your
printer to a local area network (LAN). You can install one
print server in your printer. There are MarkNetTM cards
available to support the following topologies:
•
•
Ethernet (100BaseTX, 10BaseT, 10Base2)
Token-Ring (DB9 or RJ45)
Internal print servers have a similar size and shape. Make
sure the network port on the card corresponds to your net-
work cable requirements. Refer to the documentation that
came with the print server for more information.
Network Port
Installing the Optional Internal Print Server
To install, complete the following two sections in order:
•
•
Card Connector Points
Understanding Option Cards
211
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Tri-Port Interface
Option Card
The Tri-Port interface option card lets you connect to:
•
•
•
A LocalTalk network
Serial interface (RS-232C or Serial RS-422A)
An infrared adapter
LocalTalk Port
Serial Port
An infrared adapter receives an infrared beam that allows
you to print remotely to an IrDA-compatible computer.
Installing the Tri-Port Interface Option Card
Infrared Port
Card Connector Points
To install, complete the following two sections in order:
•
•
Hard Disk Option
Like the flash memory option, the hard disk option is use-
ful for storing information such as downloaded fonts,
macros, and symbol sets.
You can also use the hard disk option to store incoming
print jobs in a buffer until they print. Since hard disk
memory provides permanent storage, job buffering to the
hard disk prevents the loss of print job data if the printer
loses power. It may also free your application faster for
other work. Job buffering is only available for jobs trans-
mitted across the standard parallel and USB interface.
Note: Data stored on the hard
disk option is kept in memory
when the printer is turned off.
Chapter 11: Memory and Option Cards
212
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
You can purchase:
•
•
A hard disk with an adapter card already installed.
A hard disk that supports Optra FormsTM with an
adapter card already installed. Refer to Optra Forms
for more information.
•
A hard disk adapter card for installing a separately
purchased hard disk.
Complete the following instructions to attach the hard
disk to the adapter card. If your disk is already attached to
Attaching a Hard Disk to the Adapter Card
You can use the adapter card with any hard disk meeting
the following criteria:
•
•
•
2.5-inch platter
ATA-2 (IDE) interface
Maximum thickness of 15 mm (.59 in.)
To attach the hard disk to the adapter card:
Adapter Card
1 Align the connector pins on the end of the hard
disk with the connector on the back of the adapter
card.
Hard Disk
Understanding Option Cards
213
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2 Push the hard disk securely into the connector.
3 Turn the adapter card over and insert the four
screws. Securely tighten each screw.
Installing the Hard Disk Option Card
To install, complete the following two sections in order:
•
•
Chapter 11: Memory and Option Cards
214
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Parallel/USB
Interface
Option Card
The parallel/ USB interface option card lets you connect
your printer to a parallel interface. You can also use the
USB (Universal Serial Bus) port to connect your printer to
Installing the Parallel/USB Interface Option Card
To install, complete the following two sections in order:
•
•
USB Port
Parallel Port
Card Connector Points
Understanding Option Cards
215
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Installing an Before installing an option card, follow the steps under
Option Card
To install a hard disk option card, optional internal print
server, Tri-Port interface option card, or parallel/ USB
interface option card:
Warning! The option card is
easily damaged by static elec-
tricity. Touch something metal
before you touch the card.
1 Locate the option card connector on the printer
system board.
card before installing another one. Otherwise, go
to step 3.
Option Card Connector
Chapter 11: Memory and Option Cards
216
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
3 Remove the metal plate covering the connector
slot.
a Locate the two screws on the back of the printer
that attach the metal plate to the slot.
b Remove and save the two screws. Remove and
discard the plate.
4 Unpack the option card.
Save the packing materials.
Faceplate Opening
5 Align the connector on the option card with the
connector on the system board.
The cable connectors on the side of the option card
must fit through the opening in the faceplate.
6 Push the option card firmly into the option card
connector on the system board.
Option Card Connector
Installing an Option Card
217
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
7 Insert the two screws saved from the metal plate
(or the extra screws shipped with the option card)
into the holes on either side of the connector slot.
8 Gently tighten the screws to secure the card to the
system board.
Chapter 11: Memory and Option Cards
218
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Removing an Before removing an option card, follow the steps under
Option Card
To remove an option card:
Warning! The option card is
easily damaged by static elec-
tricity. Touch something metal
before you touch the card.
1 Remove the two screws on either side of the con-
nector slot located on the back of the printer.
2 Pull the option card straight out of the system
board connector.
3 Place the option card in its original packaging.
If you did not save the packaging, wrap the card in
paper and store it in a box.
option card. Otherwise, go to step 5.
Removing an Option Card
219
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Closing the Printer After you have installed all of your options on the printer
system board, reattach the shield and close the side door:
System Board
1 Grasp the shield by the tabs and align the three
keyholes on the shield with the top three screws
on the side of the printer.
2 Holding the shield by the tabs, slide it down.
3 Tighten all six screws.
Tabs
Chapter 11: Memory and Option Cards
220
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
4 Hold the side door slightly to the left of the printer
and place the latches located on the back edge of
the side door against the metal shield.
The edge of the metal shield fits into the latches. The
top latch fits inside the back of the printer.
5 Close the side door, pressing on the side door
latches to snap it into place.
6 Close the upper and lower front doors.
7 Reconnect all cables to the back of the printer.
8 Reconnect the printer power cord to the printer
and a properly grounded electrical outlet.
9 Turn the printer power On (| ).
10 Make sure the Ready message appears on the oper-
ator panel display.
Note: To verify options are
Closing the Printer System Board
221
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Chapter 11: Memory and Option Cards
222
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Optional
500-Sheet
Drawer
12
Decide on a location to set the support unit. The printer will
be placed on top of it, so allow enough space for easy paper
access. The location must be sturdy and large enough to
accommodate the printer and the optional 500-sheet
drawer.
Installing the The optional drawer consists of a support unit and an
input tray. To install the optional 500-sheet drawer:
Optional Drawer
1 Turn the printer power Off (O).
2 Unplug the printer power cord.
3 Disconnect all cables from the back of the printer.
Caution! To avoid electrical
shock hazards, make sure your
computer power is Off (O) and
unplug all computer equipment
before connecting cables.
4 Remove the support unit from its packaging.
Remove any packing tape.
Installing the Optional Drawer
223
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
5 Pull the input tray out of the support unit.
Remove any packing material and tape from the
input tray.
6 Grasp the support unit on each side at opposite
corners and move it to the location being used.
7 Notice the following parts located on the top sur-
face of the optional support unit: the tab, the
round hole, and the four square holes.
Square Holes
Tab
8 Lift the printer by the handholds or ask someone
to help you lift the printer.
The bottom surface of the printer has matching
holes or feet that accommodate the tab, round hole,
and four square holes.
Square Holes
Round Hole
Caution! Make sure your fin-
gers are not under the printer
when you set it down.
Chapter 12: Optional 500-Sheet Drawer
224
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
9 Place the printer on top of the support unit.
Make sure the edges of the printer and the support
unit are aligned properly.
10 Load print material in the input tray.
information.
11 Install the input tray in the support unit.
12 Reconnect all cables to the back of the printer.
13 Plug the printer power cord into a properly
grounded electrical outlet.
14 Turn the printer power On (| ).
15 When Ready displays, press Menu> to enter the
menus.
Note: Verify that the optional
drawer is installed properly. See
16 Set the PAPER SIZE, PAPER TYPE, and PAPER
LENGTH menu settings for this paper source.
tion.
17 Press Go to return to the Ready state.
Installing the Optional Drawer
225
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Chapter 12: Optional 500-Sheet Drawer
226
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Infrared
Adapter
13
You can use an infrared adapter to print remotely to an
IrDA-compatible computer equipped with an infrared
port.
The Tri-Port interface option card, which includes an
infrared port, lets you connect the infrared adapter to your
After you install the Tri-Port interface option card, com-
plete the following steps to connect the infrared adapter to
your printer.
Connecting the To connect the infrared adapter to your printer:
Cable and Using
1 Unplug the printer power cord.
the Infrared
2 Locate the infrared port on the back of your
Adapter
printer.
The infrared port is attached to the Tri-Port interface
option card installed in your printer.
Connecting the Cable and Using the Infrared Adapter
227
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
3 Plug the adapter cable into the infrared port.
4 Reconnect the printer power cord to a properly
grounded electrical outlet.
If any light on the infrared adapter comes on when
the printer is plugged in, the adapter is connected to
the port correctly.
5 Aim the computer infrared port at the infrared
port on the front of the Tri-Port interface option
card.
Adapter
Cable
Refer to the documentation that came with your
computer for information about your computer
infrared port.
Infrared
Port
6 Draw an imaginary line between the two infrared
ports. Aim the infrared port on your computer
within 15 degrees of either side of this line, as
shown.
7 Send a job to print.
If the job does not print correctly, see Infrared Adapter
Chapter 13: Infrared Adapter
228
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Verifying the
Installation of
Options
14
You can verify that printer options are properly installed
by printing a menu settings page.
A menu settings page lists:
•
All printer settings in the operator panel menus and
their default values.
•
All installed features and options, such as the
optional 500-sheet drawer, internal print server
(also called an internal network adapter or INA),
flash memory option, printer memory option, and
hard disk option.
•
•
Amount of available printer memory.
Other printer settings.
Printing the Menu Before printing the menu settings page, make sure the
selected paper source holds letter-, legal-, or A4-size
paper, the PAPER SIZE setting is set to the correct size, and
Settings Page
the PAPER TYPE setting for the paper source is Plain Paper.
Printing the Menu Settings Page
229
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
To print a menu settings page:
1 Make sure the printer power is On (| ) and the
Ready status message appears on the display.
page 34 to identify the display and operator panel
buttons.
2 Press Menu> or <Menu to enter the menus.
3 Continue to press and release Menu> or <Menu until
you see UTILITIES MENU.
4 Press Select.
5 Press Menu> until Print Menus appears on the sec-
ond line of the display.
6 Press Select.
The message Printing Menu Settings appears and
remains on the operator panel display until the
page prints. The printer returns to the Ready state
after the menu settings page prints.
7 Check to see if the option you installed is listed.
All installed options are listed on the menu settings
page under Installed Features.
If an installed option does not appear on the page, it
is not installed correctly or aligned properly. Turn
the printer power Off (O), unplug the printer power
cord, reinstall the option, and print the menu set-
tings page again.
Chapter 14: Verifying the Installation of Options
230
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Understanding
Fonts
A
This appendix contains basic information about fonts,
their characteristics, and the specific fonts available in
PCL 6 and PostScript 3 emulations.
Typefaces A font is a set of characters and symbols created with a dis-
tinct design. The distinct design is called a typeface. The
typefaces you select add personality to a document.
Well-chosen typefaces make a document easier to read.
and Fonts
The printer has numerous resident fonts in PCL 6 and
for a listing of all resident fonts.
Weight and Style
Typefaces are often available in different weights and
styles. These variations modify the original typeface so
you can, for example, emphasize important words in text
or highlight book titles. The different weights and styles
are designed to complement the original typeface.
Weight refers to the thickness of the lines that form the
characters. Thicker lines result in darker characters. Some
words commonly used to describe the weight of a type-
face are bold, medium, light, black and heavy.
Appendix A: Understanding Fonts
231
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Style refers to other typeface modifications, such as tilt or
character width. Italic and oblique are styles where the
characters are tilted. Narrow, condensed and extended are
three common styles that modify the character widths.
Some fonts combine several weight and style modifica-
tions; for example, Helvetica Narrow Bold Italic. A group
of several weight and style variations of a single typeface
is called a typeface family. Most typeface families have four
variations: regular, italic, bold, and bold italic. Some fami-
lies have more variations, as the following illustration for
the Helvetica typeface family shows:
Pitch and Point Size
The size of a font is specified as either a pitch or point size,
depending on whether the font is fixed space or propor-
tional.
In fixed space fonts, each character has the same width.
Pitch is used to specify the size of fixed space fonts. It is a
measure of the number of characters that will print in one
horizontal inch of type. For example, all 10-pitch fonts
print 10 characters per inch (cpi) and all 12-pitch fonts
print 12 cpi:
Courier
Courier-Bold
10 Pitch 1234567890
10 Pitch 1234567890
Courier
Courier-Bold
12 Pitch
12 Pitch
123456789012
123456789012
1 inch
Appendix A: Understanding Fonts
232
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
In proportional (or typographic) fonts, every character can
have a different width. Since proportional fonts have char-
acters with different widths, the font size is specified in
point size, not pitch. Point size refers to the height of the
characters in the font. A point is defined as 1/ 72 inch. The
characters in a font printed at 24 point will be twice as
large as the characters in the same font printed at 12 point.
The following illustration shows samples of a font printed
in different point sizes:
48 point 36 point
24 point 18 point
12 point
10 point
The point size of a font is defined as the distance from the
top of the tallest character in the font to the bottom of the
lowest character in the font. Due to the definition of point
size, different fonts printed at the same point size may
appear quite different in size. This is because there are
other font parameters that affect how the font looks. How-
ever, the point size of a font is an excellent specification of
the relative size of a font. The following examples illus-
trate two very different proportional fonts at 14 point:
ITC Ava nt Ga rd e
a b c d e fg hABCDEFGH
ITC Zapf Chancery
abcdefghABCDEFGH
Appendix A: Understanding Fonts
233
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Bitmapped and The printer uses both bitmapped and scalable fonts.
Scalable Fonts
Bitmapped fonts are stored in printer memory as pre-
defined patterns of bits that represent a typeface at a spe-
cific size, style and resolution. An example of a character
from a bitmapped font is shown at left.
Bitmapped fonts are available in different type styles and
point sizes as downloadable fonts. Contact your point of
purchase for more information about downloadable fonts.
Scalable fonts are stored as computer programs that define
the outlines of the characters in the font. Each time you
print characters from a scalable font, the printer creates a
bitmap of the characters at the point size you choose and
saves it temporarily in printer memory. These temporary
bitmapped fonts are deleted when you turn off or reset the
printer. Scalable fonts provide the flexibility of printing in
many different point sizes.
Your printer uses different scalable font formats for down-
loading fonts to the printer. PCL 6 emulation uses Intelli-
font and TrueType scalable fonts. PostScript 3 emulation
uses Type 1 and TrueType scalable fonts. There are thou-
sands of different scalable fonts available in these different
font formats from numerous font suppliers.
If you plan to use many downloadable bitmapped or scal-
able fonts or if you plan to use many different sizes of scal-
able fonts, you may need to purchase additional memory
Appendix A: Understanding Fonts
234
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Resident Fonts Your printer is equipped with resident fonts stored perma-
nently in printer memory. Different fonts are available in
PCL 6 and PostScript 3 emulations. Some of the most pop-
ular typefaces, like Courier and Times New Roman, are
available for all printer languages.
The following tables list all the fonts resident in your
ples of the fonts. You can select the resident fonts from
your software application, or from the operator panel if
you are using PCL 6 emulation.
Resident Scalable Fonts
PCL 6 Emulation
PostScript 3 Emulation
AlbertusMT
Albertus Medium
AlbertusMT-Italic
AlbertusMT-Light
Albertus Extra Bold
Antique Olive
AntiqueOlive-Roman
AntiqueOlive-Italic
AntiqueOlive-Bold
AntiqueOlive-Compact
ArialMT
Antique Olive Italic
Antique Olive Bold
Arial
Arial Italic
Arial-ItalicMT
Arial Bold
Arial-BoldMT
Arial Bold Italic
Arial-BoldItalicMT
AvantGarde-Book
AvantGarde-BookOblique
AvantGarde-Demi
AvantGarde-DemiOblique
Bookman-Light
ITC Avant Garde Book
ITC Avant Garde Book Oblique
ITC Avant Garde Demi
ITC Avant Garde Demi Oblique
ITC Bookman Light
ITC Bookman Light Italic
ITC Bookman Demi
ITC Bookman Demi Italic
Clarendon Condensed Bold
Bookman-LightItalic
Bookman-Demi
Bookman-DemiItalic
Appendix A: Understanding Fonts
235
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Resident Scalable Fonts (continued)
PCL 6 Emulation
Coronet
PostScript 3 Emulation
Coronet-Regular
Courier
CourierPS
CourierPS Oblique
CourierPS Bold
Courier-Oblique
Courier-Bold
CourierPS Bold Italic
CG Omega
Courier-BoldOblique
CG Omega Bold
CG Omega Italic
CG Omega Bold Italic
Garamond Antiqua
Garamond Halbfett
Garamond Kursiv
Garamond Kursiv Halbfett
Helvetica Light
Garamond-Antiqua
Garamond-Halbfett
Garamond-Kursiv
Garamond-KursivHalbfett
Helvetica-Light
Helvetica Light Oblique
Helvetica Black
Helvetica-LightOblique
Helvetica-Black
Helvetica Black Oblique
Helvetica
Helvetica-BlackOblique
Helvetica
Helvetica Italic
Helvetica-Oblique
Helvetica Bold
Helvetica-Bold
Helvetica Bold Italic
Helvetica Narrow
Helvetica Narrow Italic
Helvetica Narrow Bold
Helvetica Narrow Bold Italic
CG Times
Helvetica-BoldOblique
Helvetica-Narrow
Helvetica-Narrow-Oblique
Helvetica-Narrow-Bold
Helvetica-Narrow-BoldOblique
Intl-CG-Times
CG Times Italic
Intl-CG-Times-Italic
Intl-CG-Times-Bold
Intl-CG-Times-BoldItalic
CG Times Bold
CG Times Bold Italic
Appendix A: Understanding Fonts
236
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Resident Scalable Fonts (continued)
PCL 6 Emulation
Univers Medium
Univers Medium Italic
Univers Bold
PostScript 3 Emulation
Intl-Univers-Medium
Intl-Univers-MediumItalic
Intl-Univers-Bold
Intl-Univers-BoldItalic
Intl-Courier
Univers Bold Italic
Courier
Courier Italic
Intl-Courier-Oblique
Intl-Courier-Bold
Intl-Courier-BoldOblique
LetterGothic
Courier Bold
Courier Bold Italic
Letter Gothic
Letter Gothic Italic
Letter Gothic Bold
LetterGothic-Slanted
LetterGothic-Bold
LetterGothic-BoldSlanted
Marigold
Marigold
Century Schoolbook Roman
Century Schoolbook Italic
Century Schoolbook Bold
Century Schoolbook Bold Italic
NewCenturySchlbk-Roman
NewCenturySchlbk-Italic
NewCenturySchlbk-Bold
NewCenturySchlbk-BoldItalic
Optima
Optima-Bold
Optima-BoldItalic
Optima-Italic
Palatino Roman
Palatino Italic
Palatino Bold
Palatino Bold Italic
SymbolPS
Palatino-Roman
Palatino-Italic
Palatino-Bold
Palatino-BoldItalic
Symbol
Symbol
Times Roman
Times Italic
Times-Roman
Times-Italic
Appendix A: Understanding Fonts
237
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Resident Scalable Fonts (continued)
PCL 6 Emulation
PostScript 3 Emulation
Times-Bold
Times Bold
Times Bold Italic
Times-BoldItalic
Times New Roman
Times New Roman Italic
Times New Roman Bold
Times New Roman Bold Italic
TimesNewRomanPSMT
TimesNewRomanPS-ItalicMT
TimesNewRomanPS-BoldMT
TimesNewRomanPS-BoldItalicMT
Univers
Univers-Oblique
Univers-Bold
Univers-BoldOblique
Univers-Condensed
Univers-CondensedOblique
Univers-CondensedBold
Univers-CondensedBoldOblique
Wingdings-Regular
Univers Condensed Medium
Univers Condensed Medium Italic
Univers Condensed Bold
Univers Condensed Bold Italic
Wingdings
ITC Zapf Chancery Medium Italic
ITC Zapf Dingbats
ZapfChancery-MediumItalic
ZapfDingbats
Resident Bitmapped Fonts
PCL 6 Emulation
Line Printer 16
PostScript 3 Emulation
POSTNET Barcode
Appendix A: Understanding Fonts
238
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Symbol Sets A symbol set is the collection of alphabetic and numeric
characters, punctuation, and special characters available
in the font you select. Symbol sets support the require-
ments for different languages or specific applications,
such as math symbols used for scientific text.
In PCL 6 emulation, a symbol set also defines which char-
acter will print for each key on the keyboard (or more spe-
cifically, for each code point). Some applications require
different characters at some code points. To support multi-
ple applications and languages, your printer has 83
symbol sets for the resident PCL 6 emulation fonts.
Symbol Sets for
PCL 6 Emulation
Not all font names support all of the symbol sets listed.
Refer to the Technical Reference to determine which sym-
bols sets are supported by each font name.
ABICOMP Brazil/Portugal
ABICOMP International
DeskTop
Legal
MC Text
Microsoft Publishing
Russian-GOST
Ukrainian
PCL ITC Zapf Dingbats
PS ITC Zapf Dingbats
PS Math
PS Text
Pi Font
Symbol
Wingdings
POSTNET Barcode
ISO : German
ISO : Spanish
ISO 2: IRV (Int'l Ref Version)
ISO 4: United Kingdom
ISO 6: ASCII
ISO 10: Swedish
ISO 11: Swedish for Names
ISO 14: JIS ASCII
ISO 15: Italian
ISO 16: Portuguese
ISO 17: Spanish
ISO 21: German
ISO 25: French
ISO 57: Chinese
ISO 60: Norwegian version 1
ISO 61: Norwegian version 2
Appendix A: Understanding Fonts
239
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
ISO 69: French
ISO 84: Portuguese
ISO 85: Spanish
ISO 8859-1 Latin 1 (ECMA-94)
ISO 8859-2 Latin 2
ISO 8859-5 Latin/Cyrillic
ISO 8859-7 Latin/Greek
ISO 8859-9 Latin 5
ISO 8859-10 Latin 6
ISO 8859-15 Latin 9
PC-8 Bulgarian
PC-8 Danish/Norwegian (437N)
PC-8 Greek Alternate (437G)
PC-8 Turkish (437T)
PC-8 Latin/Greek
PC-8 PC Nova
PC-8 Polish Mazovia
PC-8 Code Page 437
PC-775 Baltic (PC-8 Latin 6)
PC-850 Multilingual
PC-851 Greece
PC-852 Latin 2
PC-853 Latin 3 (Turkish)
PC-855 Cyrillic
PC-857 Latin 5 (Turkish)
PC-858 Multilingual Euro
PC-860 Portugal
PC-861 Iceland
PC-863 Canadian French
PC-865 Nordic
PC-866 Cyrillic
PC-869 Greece
PC-911 Katakana
PC-1004 OS/2
Math-8
Greek-8
Turkish-8
Roman-8
Roman-9
Roman Extension
Ventura ITC Zapf Dingbats
Ventura International
Ventura Math
Ventura US
Windows 3.0 Latin 1
Windows 98 Cyrillic
Windows 98 Greek
Windows 98 Latin 1
Windows 98 Latin 2
Windows 98 Latin 5
Windows 98 Latin 6 (Baltic)
Appendix A: Understanding Fonts
240
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Downloadable You can download scalable fonts in PostScript 3 emulation
and either scalable or bitmapped fonts in PCL 6 emula-
Fonts
tion. Fonts can be downloaded to printer memory or to a
flash memory option or hard disk option. Fonts down-
loaded to flash memory or hard disk remain in memory
even after the printer language changes, the printer resets,
or the printer is turned off.
The MarkVision utility includes a remote management
function that lets you manipulate the font files you have
more information about MarkVision.
Appendix A: Understanding Fonts
241
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Printing a Font To print samples of all the fonts currently available for
your printer:
Sample List
1 Make sure the printer power is On (| ) and the
Ready status message appears on the display.
2 Press Menu> or <Menu to enter the menus.
3 Continue to press and release Menu> until you see
UTILITIES MENU.
4 Press Select.
5 Press Menu> until Print Fonts appears.
6 Press Select.
7 Press Menu> or <Menu until either PCL Fonts or
PS Fonts appears on the second line of the display.
– Select PCL Fonts to print a listing of the fonts
available to the PCL emulator.
– Select PS Fonts to print a listing of the fonts avail-
able to the PostScript 3 emulator.
8 Press Select.
The message Printing Font List appears and remains
on the operator panel display until the page prints.
The printer returns to the Ready state after the font
sample list prints.
Appendix A: Understanding Fonts
242
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Notices
B
Electronic Emissions
Notices
Electronic emission information for your printer varies, depending on whether or not
you have an optional network adapter installed.
Warning
With a network adapter installed, this is a Class A product. In a domestic environment,
this product may cause radio interference, in which case the user may be required to
take adequate measures.
Without a Network
Adapter Installed
Federal Communications Commission (FCC) Compliance
Information Statement
The Lexmark Optra M410 and M412 laser printers, Type 4045, have been tested and
found to comply with the limits for a Class B digital device, pursuant to Part 15 of the
FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the following two conditions: (1) this device may not
cause harmful interference, and (2) this device must accept any interference received,
including interference that may cause undesired operation.
The FCC Class B limits are designed to provide reasonable protection against harmful
interference in a residential installation. This equipment generates, uses and can radiate
radio frequency energy and, if not installed and used in accordance with the instruc-
tions, may cause harmful interference to radio communications. However, there is no
guarantee that interference will not occur in a particular installation. If this equipment
does cause harmful interference to radio or television reception, which can be deter-
mined by turning the equipment off and on, the user is encouraged to try to correct the
interference by one or more of the following measures:
•
•
•
Reorient or relocate the receiving antenna.
Increase the separation between the equipment and receiver.
Connect the equipment into an outlet on a circuit different from that to which
the receiver is connected.
•
Consult your point of purchase or service representative for additional sug-
gestions.
The manufacturer is not responsible for any radio or television interference caused by
using other than recommended cables or by unauthorized changes or modifications to
this equipment. Unauthorized changes or modifications could void the user’s authority
to operate this equipment.
Appendix B: Notices
243
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
To assure compliance with FCC regulations on electromagnetic interference for a Class
B computing device, use a properly shielded and grounded cable such as Lexmark part
number 1329605 for parallel and 12A2405 for USB. Use of a substitute cable not prop-
erly shielded and grounded may result in a violation of FCC regulations.
Any questions regarding this compliance information statement should be directed to:
Director of Lab Operations
Lexmark International, Inc.
740 West New Circle Road
Lexington, KY 40550
(606) 232-3000
Industry Canada Compliance Statement
This Class B digital apparatus meets all requirements of the Canadian Interference-
Causing Equipment Regulations.
Avis de conformité aux normes d’Industrie Canada
Cet appareil numérique de la classe B respecte toutes les exigences du Règlement sur le
matériel brouilleur du Canada.
European Community (EC) Directives Conformity
This product is in conformity with the protection requirements of EC Council directives
89/ 336/ EEC and 73/ 23/ EEC on the approximation and harmonization of the laws of
the Member States relating to electromagnetic compatibility and safety of electrical
equipment designed for use within certain voltage limits.
A declaration of conformity with the requirements of the Directive has been signed by
the Director of Manufacturing and Technical Support, Lexmark International, S.A., Boi-
gny, France.
This product satisfies the Class B limits of EN 55022 and safety requirements of EN
60950.
Appendix B: Notices
244
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
With a Network Adapter
Installed
Federal Communications Commission (FCC) Compliance
Information Statement
The Lexmark Optra M410n and M412n laser printers, Type 4045, have been tested and
found to comply with the limits for a Class A digital device, pursuant to Part 15 of the
FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the following two conditions: (1) this device may not
cause harmful interference, and (2) this device must accept any interference received,
including interference that may cause undesired operation.
The FCC Class A limits are designed to provide reasonable protection against harmful
interference when the equipment is operated in a commercial environment. This equip-
ment generates, uses, and can radiate radio frequency energy and, if not installed and
used in accordance with the instruction manual, may cause harmful interference to
radio communications. Operation of this equipment in a residential area is likely to
cause harmful interference in which case the user will be required to correct the interfer-
ence at his own expense.
The manufacturer is not responsible for any radio or television interference caused by
using other than recommended cables or by unauthorized changes or modifications to
this equipment. Unauthorized changes or modifications could void the user’s authority
to operate this equipment.
Note: To assure compliance with FCC regulations on electromagnetic interference for a
Class A computing device, use a properly shielded and grounded cable such as Lex-
mark part number 1329605 for parallel and 12A2405 for USB. Use of a substitute cable
not properly shielded and grounded may result in a violation of FCC regulations.
Industry Canada Compliance Statement
This Class A digital apparatus meets all requirements of the Canadian Interference-
Causing Equipment Regulations.
Avis de conformité aux normes d’Industrie Canada
Cet appareil numérique de la classe A respecte toutes les exigences du Règlement sur le
matériel brouilleur du Canada.
European Community (EC) Directives Conformity
This product is in conformity with the protection requirements of EC Council directives
89/ 336/ EEC and 73/ 23/ EEC on the approximation and harmonization of the laws of
the Member States relating to electromagnetic compatibility and safety of electrical
equipment designed for use within certain voltage limits.
A declaration of conformity with the requirements of the Directive has been signed by
the Director of Manufacturing and Technical Support, Lexmark International, S.A., Boi-
gny, France.
This product satisfies the Class A limits of EN 55022 and safety requirements of EN
60950.
Appendix B: Notices
245
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
The United Kingdom
Telecommunications Act
1984
This apparatus is approved under the approval number NS/ G/ 1234/ J/ 100003 for the
indirect connections to the public telecommunications systems in the United Kingdom.
German Acoustics
Statement
The following measurements were made in accordance with ISO 7779 and reported in
conformance with ISO 9296.
Acoustics
1-Meter Average
Sound Pressure,
dBA
Printing
Idling
Optra M410
48 dBA
Optra M412
50 dBA
30 dBA
30 dBA
Energy Star
The EPA ENERGY STAR Computers program is a partnership effort with computer
manufacturers to promote the introduction of energy-efficient products and to reduce
air pollution caused by power generation.
Companies participating in this program introduce personal computers, printers, moni-
tors, or fax machines that power down when they are not being used. This feature will
cut the energy used by up to 50 percent. Lexmark is proud to be a participant in this
program.
As an Energy Star Partner, Lexmark International, Inc. has determined that this product
meets the Energy Star guidelines for energy efficiency.
Appendix B: Notices
246
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Class 1 Laser
Statement Label
CLASS 1 LASER PRODUCT
LASER KLASSE 1
LUOKAN 1 LASERLAITE
APPAREIL À LASER DE CLASSE 1
TO IEC 825
Laser Notice
The printer is certified in the U.S. to conform to the requirements of DHHS 21 CFR
Subchapter J for Class I (1) laser products, and elsewhere is certified as a Class I laser
product conforming to the requirements of IEC 60825-1.
Class I laser products are not considered to be hazardous. The printer contains inter-
nally a Class IIIb (3b) laser that is nominally a 5 milliwatt aluminum gallium arsenide
laser operating in the wavelength region of 770-795 nanometers. The laser system and
printer are designed so there is never any human access to laser radiation above a Class
I level during normal operation, user maintenance, or prescribed service condition.
Laser
Der Drucker erfüllt gemäß amtlicher Bestätigung der USA die Anforderungen der
Bestimmung DHHS (Department of Health and Human Services) 21 CFR Teil J für
Laserprodukte der Klasse I (1). In anderen Ländern gilt der Drucker als Laserprodukt
der Klasse I, der die Anforderungen der IEC (International Electrotechnical
Commission) 60825-1 gemäß amtlicher Bestätigung erfüllt.
Laserprodukte der Klasse I gelten als unschädlich. Der Drucker ist intern mit einem
Laser der Klasse IIIb (3b) ausgestattet. Hierbei handelt es sich nominell um einen 5-
Milliwatt-Aluminium-Galliumarsenidlaser, der in einem Wellenlängenbereich von 770
bis 795 Nanometern arbeitet. Das Lasersystem und der Drucker sind so konzipiert, daß
im Normalbetrieb, bei der Wartung durch den Benutzer oder bei ordnungsgemäßer
Wartung durch den Kundendienst Laserbestrahlung, die die Klasse I übersteigen
würde, Menschen keinesfalls erreicht.
Appendix B: Notices
248
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Avis relatif à l’utilisation
Pour les Etats-Unis : cette imprimante est certifiée conforme aux provisions DHHS 21
CFR alinéa J concernant les produits laser de Classe I (1). Pour les autres pays : cette
imprimante répond aux normes IEC 60825-1 relatives aux produits laser de Classe I.
de laser
Les produits laser de Classe I sont considérés comme des produits non dangereux.
L'imprimante contient un laser interne de classe IIIb (3b) ; il s'agit d'un laser semi-
conducteur à arséniure de gallium de 5 mw en aluminim utilisant la plage de la
longueur d'ondes située entre 770 et 795 nanomètres. L’imprimante et son système laser
sont conçus pour impossible, dans des conditions normales d’utilisation, d’entretien
par l’utilisateur ou de révision, l’exposition à des rayonnements laser supérieurs à des
rayonnements de Classe I .
Avvertenze sui prodotti
laser
Questa stampante è certificata negli Stati Uniti per essere conforme ai requisiti del
DHHS 21 CFR Sottocapitolo J per i prodotti laser di classe 1 ed è certificata negli altri
Paesi come prodotto laser di classe 1 conforme ai requisiti della norma CEI 60825-1.
I prodotti laser di classe non sono considerati pericolosi. La stampante contiene al suo
interno un laser di Classe IIIb (3b) che è un laser all'arsenito gallio a 5 milliwatt di
alluminio funzionante nell'intervallo di lunghezza d'onda di 770-795 nanometri. Il
sistema laser e la stampante sono stati progettati in modo tale che le persone a contatto
con la stampante, durante il normale funzionamento, le operazioni di servizio o quelle
di assistenza tecnica, non ricevano radiazioni laser superiori al livello della classe 1.
Avisos sobre el láser
Declaração sobre laser
Laserinformatie
Se certifica que, en los EE.UU., esta impresora cumple los requisitos para los productos
láser de Clase I (1) establecidos en el subcapítulo J de la norma CFR 21 del DHHS
(Departamento de Sanidad y Servicios) y, en los demás países, reúne todas las
condiciones expuestas en la norma IEC 60825-1 para productos láser de Clase I (1).
Los productos láser de Clase I no se consideran peligrosos. La impresora contiene en su
interior un láser de la clase IIIb (3b) que se trata de un láser de arseniuro de galio con 5
milivatios de aluminio que funciona en el intervalo de longitud de onda entre 770 y 795
nanómetros. El sistema láser y la impresora están diseñados de forma que ninguna
persona pueda verse afectada por ningún tipo de radiación láser superior al nivel de la
Clase I durante su uso normal, el mantenimiento realizado por el usuario o cualquier
otra situación de servicio técnico.
A impressora está certificada nos E.U.A. em conformidade com os requisitos da
regulamentação DHHS 21 CFR Subcapítulo J para a Classe I (1) de produtos laser. Em
outros locais, está certificada como um produto laser da Classe I, em conformidade com
os requisitos da norma IEC 60825-1.
Os produtos laser da Classe I não são considerados perigosos. A impressora contém no
seu interior um laser Classe IIIb (3b) que é nominalmente um laser de 5 miliwatts de
alumínio de arseneto de gálio a operar na região de comprimento de onda de 770-795
nanómetros. O sistema e a impressora laser foram concebidos de forma a nunca existir
qualquer possiblidade de acesso humano a radiação laser superior a um nível de Classe
I durante a operação normal, a manutenção feita pelo utilizador ou condições de
assistência prescritas.
De printer voldoet aan de eisen die gesteld worden aan een laserprodukt van klasse I.
Voor de Verenigde Staten zijn deze eisen vastgelegd in DHHS 21 CFR Subchapter J,
voor andere landen in IEC 60825-1.
Laserprodukten van klasse I worden niet als ongevaarlijk aangemerkt. De printer bevat
een interne 5 aluminium milliwatt gallium arsenide laser van Klasse IIIb (3b) die werkt
in de golflengte 770-795 nanometer. Het lasergedeelte en de printer zijn zo ontworpen
dat bij normaal gebruik, bij onderhoud of reparatie conform de voorschriften, nooit
blootstelling mogelijk is aan laserstraling boven een niveau zoals voorgeschreven is
voor klasse 1.
Appendix B: Notices
249
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Lasermeddelelse
Printeren er godkendt som et Klasse I-laserprodukt, i overenstemmelse med kravene i
IEC 60825-1.
Klasse I-laserprodukter betragtes ikke som farlige. Printeren indeholder en Class IIIb
(3b)-laser, der nominelt er en 5 aluminum milliwatt gallium arsenid-laser, som arbejder
i et bølgelængdeområde af 770-795 nanometer. Lasersystemet og printeren er udformet
således, at mennesker aldrig udsættes for en laserstråling over Klasse I-niveau ved
normal drift, brugervedligeholdelse eller obligatoriske servicebetingelser.
Huomautus laserlaitteesta
Tämä kirjoitin on Yhdysvalloissa luokan I (1) laserlaitteiden DHHS 21 CFR Subchapter J
-määrityksen mukainen ja muualla luokan I laserlaitteiden IEC 60825-1 -määrityksen
mukainen.
Luokan I laserlaitteiden ei katsota olevan vaarallisia käyttäjälle. Tulostin sisältää luokan
IIIb (3b) alumiinigalliumarsenidilaserin, joka toimii 5 milliwatin nimellisteholla ja 770 -
795 nanometrin aallonpituusalueella. Laserjärjestelmä ja kirjoitin on suunniteltu siten,
että käyttäjä ei altistu luokan I määrityksiä voimakkaammalle säteilylle kirjoittimen
normaalin toiminnan, käyttäjän tekemien huoltotoimien tai muiden huoltotoimien
yhteydessä.
LUOKAN 1 LASERLAITE
VAROITUS! Laitteen käyttäminen muulla kuin tässä käyttöohjeessa mainitulla tavalla
saattaa altistaa käyttäjän turvallisuusluokan 1 ylittävälle näkymättömälle
lasersäteilylle.
KLASS 1 LASER APPARAT
VARNING! Om apparaten används på annat sätt än i denna bruksanvisning
specificerats, kan användaren utsättas för osynlig laserstrålning, som överskrider
gränsen för laserklass 1.
Laser-notis
Denna skrivare är i USA certifierad att motsvara kraven i DHHS 21 CFR, underparagraf
J för laserprodukter av Klass I (1). I andra länder uppfyller skrivaren kraven för
laserprodukter av Klass I enligt kraven i IEC 60825-1.
Laserprodukter i Klass I anses ej hälsovådliga. Skrivaren innehåller en inbyggd 5
milliwatts galliumarsenidlaser av klass IIIb (3b), som arbetar med våglänger i
intervallet 770-795 nanometer. Lasersystemet och skrivaren är utformade så att det
aldrig finns risk för att någon person utsätts för laserstrålning över Klass I-nivå vid
normal användning, underhåll som utförs av användaren eller annan föreskriven
serviceåtgärd.
Laser-melding
Skriveren er godkjent i USA etter kravene i DHHS 21 CFR, underkapittel J, for klasse I
(1) laserprodukter, og er i andre land godkjent som et Klasse I-laserprodukt i samsvar
med kravene i IEC 60825-1.
Klasse I-laserprodukter er ikke å betrakte som farlige. Skriveren har en innebygd laser i
klasse IIIb (3b) som nominelt er en 5 milliwatts galliumaluminiumarsenidlaser som
opererer med bølgelengder i området 770-795 nanometer. Lasersystemet og skriveren er
utformet slik at personer aldri utsettes for laserstråling ut over klasse I-nivå under
vanlig bruk, vedlikehold som utføres av brukeren, eller foreskrevne serviceoperasjoner.
Appendix B: Notices
250
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Avís sobre el làser
Segons ha estat certificat als Estats Units, aquesta impressora compleix els requisits de
DHHS 21 CFR, apartat J, pels productes làser de classe I (1), i segons ha estat certificat
en altres llocs, és un producte làser de classe I que compleix els requisits d’IEC 60825-1.
Els productes làser de classe I no es consideren perillosos. La impressora conté
internament un làser de la classe IIIb (3b) que nominalment es tracta d'un làser
d'arsenur de gal·li amb 5 milivats d'alumini que funciona a l'interval de longitud d'ona
entre 770 i 795 nanòmetres. El sistema làser i la impressora han sigut concebuts de
manera que mai hi hagi exposició a la radiació làser per sobre d’un nivell de classe I
durant una operació normal, durant les tasques de manteniment d’usuari ni durant els
serveis que satisfacin les condicions prescrites.
Chinese Laser Notice
Appendix B: Notices
251
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Appendix B: Notices
252
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Safety
Information
C
Safety Information
•
•
•
•
If your product is NOT marked with this symbol
to an electrical outlet that is properly grounded.
, it MUST be connected
The power cord must be connected to an electrical outlet that is near the prod-
uct and easily accessible.
Refer service or repairs, other than those described in the operating instruc-
tions, to a professional service person.
This product is designed, tested and approved to meet strict global safety stan-
dards with the use of specific Lexmark components. The safety features of
some parts may not always be obvious. Lexmark is not responsible for the use
of other replacement parts.
•
•
Your product uses a laser, exercise
CAUTION: Use of controls or adjustments or performance of procedures
other than those specified herein may result in hazardous radiation
exposure.
Your product uses a printing process that heats the print media, and the heat
may cause the media to release emissions. You must understand the section in
your operating instructions that discusses the guidelines for selecting print
media to avoid the possibility of harmful emissions.
Appendix C: Safety Information
253
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Consignes de sécurité
•
•
•
•
Si le symbole
branché sur une prise de courant mise à la terre.
n'apparaît PAS sur votre produit, ce dernier DOIT être
Le câble d'alimentation doit être connecté à une prise de courant placée près
du produit et facilement accessible.
L'entretien et les réparations autres que ceux décrits dans les instructions
d'emploi doivent être effectués par le personnel de maintenance qualifié.
Ce produit a été conçu, testé et approuvé pour respecter les normes strictes de
sécurité globale lors de l'utilisation de composants Lexmark spécifiques. Les
caractéristiques de sécurité de certains éléments ne sont pas toujours évi-
dentes. Lexmark ne peut être tenu responsable de l'utilisation d'autres pièces
de rechange.
•
•
Le produit utilise un laser :
ATTENTION : Les commandes, les réglages et l'exécution de toute autre
procédure que celle indiquée dans le présent document peuvent entraîner
des risques de radiations.
Le produit utilise un système d'impression qui chauffe le support d'impres-
sion duquel peuvent alors se dégager des émissions. Vous devez consulter les
directives générales dans la section appropriée des instructions d'emploi pour
savoir comment empêcher que ces émissions ne se produisent.
Norme di sicurezza
•
•
•
•
Se il prodotto NON è contrassegnato con questo simbolo
legato lo stesso ad una presa elettrica con messa a terra.
DEVE essere col-
Il cavo di alimentazione deve essere collegato ad una presa elettrica posta
nelle vicinanze del prodotto e facilmente raggiungibile.
Per la manutenzione o le riparazioni, escluse quelle descritte nelle istruzioni
operative, consultare il personale di assistenza autorizzato.
Il prodotto è stato progettato, testato e approvato in conformità a severi stan-
dard di sicurezza e per l’utilizzo con componenti Lexmark specifici. Le carat-
teristiche di sicurezza di alcune parti non sempre sono di immediata
comprensione. Lexmark non è responsabile per l’utilizzo di parti di ricambio
di altri produttori.
•
•
Poiché il prodotto in questione utilizza il laser, considerare il seguente avverti-
mento:
ATTENZIONE: L'uso di dispositivi di controllo o di regolazione, o l'esecuz-
ione di procedure non incluse tra quelle descritte in questa documentazi-
one, può provocare una pericolosa esposizione alle radiazioni.
Il prodotto in questione utilizza un processo di stampa che riscalda i supporti
di stampa; il calore generato può determinare l'emissione di sostanze dannose
da parte dei supporti. Leggere attentamente la sezione riportata nelle istruzi-
oni riguardante le operazioni di selezione dei supporti di stampa in modo da
evitare la possibilità di emissioni dannose.
Appendix C: Safety Information
254
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Sicherheitshinweise
•
•
•
•
Falls der Drucker nicht mit diesem Symbol
ordnungsgemäß geerdete Steckdose angeschlossen werden.
markiert ist, muß er an eine
Das Netzkabel muß an eine Steckdose angeschlossen werden, die sich in der
Nähe des Geräts befindet und leicht zugänglich ist.
Wartungsarbeiten und Reparaturen, mit Ausnahme der in der Betriebsanlei-
tung näher beschriebenen, sollten Fachleuten überlassen werden.
Dieses Produkt und die zugehörigen Komponenten wurden entworfen und
getestet, um beim Einsatz die weltweit gültigen Sicherheitsanforderungen zu
erfüllen. Die sicherheitsrelevanten Funktionen der Bauteile und Optionen sind
nicht immer offensichtlich. Sofern Teile eingesetzt werden, die nicht von Lex-
mark sind, wird von Lexmark keinerlei Verantwortung oder Haftung für
dieses Produkt übernommen.
•
•
Dieses Produkt verwendet einen Laser. Wenden Sie daher besondere
VORSICHT an: Die Verwendung von Kontrollen bzw. die Regulierung von
Vorgängen mit Ausnahme derjenigen, die in dieser Betriebsanleitung
behandelt werden, kann Sie gefährlicher Bestrahlung aussetzen.
Dieses Produkt verwendet ein Druckverfahren, bei dem das Druckmedium
erhitzt wird. Diese Erwärmung kann zu einer Freigabe von Emissionen des
Druckmediums führen. Es ist daher wichtig, daß Sie in der Betriebsanleitung
den Abschnitt, der sich mit der Auswahl geeigneter Druckmedien befaßt,
sorgfältig durchlesen und die dort aufgeführten Richtlinien befolgen, um der
Gefahr schädlicher Emissionen vorzubeugen.
Pautas de Seguridad
•
•
•
Si su producto NO tiene este símbolo,
una toma de corriente eléctrica con toma de tierra correcta.
, es IMPRESCINDIBLE conectarlo a
El cable de alimentación deberá conectarse a una toma de corriente situada
cerca del producto y de fácil acceso.
Cualquier servicio o reparación deberá realizarse por parte del personal cuali-
ficado, a menos que se trate de las averías descritas en las instrucciones de uti-
lización.
•
Este producto se ha diseñado, verificado y aprobado para cumplir los más
estrictos estándares de seguridad global usando los componentes específicos
de Lexmark. Puede que las características de seguridad de algunas piezas no
sean siempre evidentes. Lexmark no se hace responsable del uso de otras pie-
zas de recambio.
•
•
El producto utiliza un láser. Actúe con
PRECAUCION: El uso de los controles o ajustes o el llevar a cabo proced-
imientos distintos a los especificados aquí puede causar niveles de radi-
ación peligrosos.
Durante el proceso de impresión que utiliza este producto se calienta el medio
de impresión, y el calor puede provocar que el medio emita gases. Para evitar
emisiones peligrosas, el usuario deberá comprender y seguir lo expuesto en la
sección de las instrucciones de utilización donde se describen las directrices
para seleccionar el medio de impresión.
Appendix C: Safety Information
255
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Veiligheidsvoorschriften
•
Zorg ervoor dat uw produkt is aangesloten op een geaard stopcontact als het
produkt NIET is gemarkeerd met det symbool
.
•
•
Het netsnoer moet worden aangesloten op een gemakkelijk bereikbaar stop-
contact in de buurt van het produkt.
Neem contact op met een professionele onderhoudstechnicus voor onderhoud
en reparaties die niet in de bij het produkt geleverde instructies beschreven
worden.
•
•
•
Dit product is ontworpen, getest en goedgekeurd om te voldoen aan strenge
internationale veiligheidsvoorschriften. Deveiligheidsvoorzieningen van
bepaalde onderdelen zullen niet altijd duidelijk zichtbaar zijn. Lexmark is niet
verantwoordelijk voor het gebruik van andere vervangende onderdelen.
Uw produkt maakt gebruik van een laser, wees
VOORZICHTIG: Instellen van het controlepaneel of, aanpassingen of
uitvoering van procedures op andere wijze dan hier is gespecificeerd kun-
nen leiden tot blootstelling aan gevaarlijke straling.
Uw produkt gebruikt een afdrukproces waarbij het afdrukmateriaal verhit
raakt. Hierdoor kan straling vrijkomen. Lees het gedeelte in de bij het produkt
geleverde instructies, waarin richtlijnen voor de keuze van afdrukmateriaal
worden beschreven, zorgvuldig door, zodat u mogelijke schadelijke straling
kunt voorkomen.
Sikkerhedsoplysninger
•
•
•
•
Hvis dit produkt IKKE er markeret med dette symbol
til en stikkontakt med jordforbindelse.
, SKAL det sluttes
Ledningen skal sluttes til en stikkontakt, der er tæt på produktet og som er let
tilgængelig.
Service og reparationer, som ikke er beskrevet i brugsanvisningen, skal
udføres af en kvalificeret tekniker.
Dette produkt er udviklet, testet og godkendt i overensstemmelse med Lex-
marks verdensomspændende standarder for sikkerhed. Delenes sikkerheds-
funktioner kan være skjulte. Lexmark påtager sig intet ansvar for brugen af
uoriginale reservedele.
•
•
Dit produkt bruger en laser og du skal være
FORSIGTIG: Brug af styremekanismer, indstillinger eller fremgangsmåder,
som ikke er beskrevet her, kan resultere i farlig radioaktiv bestråling.
Produktet benytter en udskrivningsproces, der opvarmer skrivemediet og
denne varme kan føre til at udskriftmedier afgiver dampe. Det er vigtigt at du
forstår den del af brugsanvisningen, der omhandler valg af udskriftsmedium,
så du kan undgå farlige dampe.
Appendix C: Safety Information
256
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Sikkerhetsinformasjon
•
•
•
•
Hvis produktet ditt ikke er merket med dette symbolet,
kobles til en stikkontakt som er jordet.
, må det bare
Ledningen må være koblet til en stikkontakt nær produktet. Stikkontakten må
være lett tilgjengelig.
La bare kvalifisert personale ta seg av service og reparasjon som ikke er
direkte beskrevet i bruksanvisningen.
Dette produktet er utviklet, testet og godkjent i overensstemmelse med
strenge verdensomspennende sikkerhetsstandarder for bestemte Lexmark-
deler. Delenes sikkerhetsfunksjoner kan være skjulte. Lexmark er ikke ans-
varlig for bruk av uoriginale reservedeler.
•
•
Produktet ditt bruker en laser.
ADVARSEL: Bruk av styremekanismer, innstillinger eller fremgangsmåter
som ikke er beskrevet her, kan resultere i farlig utstråling.
Produktet ditt bruker en utskriftsprosess som varmer opp skrivemediet, og
varmen kan føre til utslipp. Forsikre deg om at du forstår den delen av bruk-
sanvisningen som omhandler valg av utskriftsmedium, slik at du kan unngå
farlige utslipp.
Säkerhetsanvisningar
•
•
•
•
Om produkten INTE är märkt med denna symbol
till ett jordat vägguttag.
MÅSTE den anslutas
Nätkabeln måste anslutas till ett lättåtkomligt vägguttag i närheten av maski-
nen.
Låt endast utbildad servicepersonal utföra sådan service och sådana repara-
tioner som inte beskrivs i handledningen.
Denna produkt är utformad, testad och godkänd för att uppfylla interna-
tionella säkerhetsbestämmelser när den används tillsammans med andra Lex-
mark-produkter. Säkerhetsegenskaperna för vissa delar är inte helt
uppenbara. Lexmark frånsäger sig ansvaret om delar av ett annat fabrikat
används.
•
•
Var försiktig - maskinen använder laser.
VARNING! Det finns risk att du utsätter dig för hälsovådlig strålning om
du använder andra reglage eller justeringar, eller om du utför andra proce-
durer än de som beskrivs här.
Maskinen använder en utskriftsmetod som upphettar utskriftsmaterialet. Het-
tan kan i vissa fall leda till att materialet avger partiklar. Undvik skadliga par-
tiklar genom att noga läsa det avsnitt i handledningen som beskriver hur man
väljer utskriftsmaterial.
Appendix C: Safety Information
257
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Informació de Seguretat
•
•
•
•
Si el vostre producte NO està marcat amb el símbol
nectar a una presa elèctrica de terra.
, S’HAURÀ de con-
El cable de potència s’haurà de connectar a una presa de corrent propera al
producte i fàcilment accessible.
Si heu de fer una reparació que no figuri entre les descrites a les instruccions
de funcionament, confieu-la a un professional.
Aquest producte està dissenyat, comprovat i aprovat per tal d'acomplir les
estrictes normes de seguretat globals amb la utililització de components espe-
cífics de Lexmark. Les característiques de seguretat d'algunes peces pot ser
que no sempre siguin òbvies. Lexmark no es responsabilitza de l'us d'altres
peces de recanvi.
•
•
El vostre producte funciona amb un làser. Procediu amb
PRECAUCIÓ: La utilització de controls, els ajustaments o la realització de
procediments distints dels especificats aquí poden donar lloc a una
exposició a radiacions perillosa.
El vostre producte fa servir un procediment d’impressió que escalfa el mitjà
d’impressió, i la calor pot fer que aquest mitjà alliberi emissions. Llegiu atenta-
ment l’apartat de les instruccions de funcionament on s’exposen les directrius
de selecció del mitjà d’emissió per tal d’evitar la possibilitat d’emissions
nocives.
Turvaohjeet
•
•
•
•
Jos tuotteessa ei ole tätä tunnusta,
pistorasiaan.
, sen saa kytkeä vain maadoitettuun
Tuotteen verkkojohto on kytkettävä sitä lähellä olevaan pistorasiaan.
Varmista, että kulku pistorasian luo on esteetön.
Muut kuin käyttöohjeissa mainitut huolto- tai korjaustoimet on jätettävä huol-
toedustajalle.
Tämä tuote on testattu ja hyväksytty. Se täyttää korkeat maailmanlaajuiset tur-
vallisuusvaatimukset, kun siinä käytetään tiettyjä Lexmarkin valmistusosia.
Joidenkin osien turvallisuusominaisuudet eivät aina ole itsestään selviä. Lex-
mark ei vastaa muiden kuin alkuperäisten osien käytöstä.
•
•
Laite sisältää lasertuotteen.
Varoitus: Muiden kuin tässä mainittujen säätöjen tai toimien teko voi saat-
taa käyttäjän alttiiksi vaaralliselle säteilylle.
Tulostusmateriaali kuumenee tulostusprosessin aikana. Lämmön vaikutuk-
sesta materiaalista saattaa irrota haitallisia aineita. Voit välttää haitalliset
päästöt noudattamalla käyttöohjeissa annettuja tulostusmateriaalien valintao-
hjeita.
Appendix C: Safety Information
258
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Informações de Segurança
•
•
•
•
Se o produto NÃO estiver marcado com este símbolo,
a uma tomada com ligação à terra.
, é necessário ligá-lo
O cabo deve ser ligado a uma tomada localizada perto do produto e facilmente
acessível.
Para todos os serviços ou reparações não referidos nas instruções de operação,
deve contactar um técnico dos serviços de assistência.
Este produto foi concebido, testado e aprovado para satisfazer os padrões glo-
bais de segurança na utilização de componentes específicos da Lexmark. As
funções de segurança de alguns dos componentes podem não ser sempre
óbvias. A Lexmark não é responsável pela utilização de outros componentes
de substituição.
•
•
O produto utiliza raios laser, tome
CUIDADO: O uso de controlos, ajustamentos ou a execução de procedimen-
tos diferentes dos especificados podem ocasionar exposição perigosa a radi-
ações.
O produto utiliza um processo de impressão que aquece os materiais de
impressão. Devido ao aquecimento, estes podem libertar emissões radioacti-
vas. É necessário compreender as instruções de operação relativas à escolha
dos materiais de impressão a fim de evitar emissões perigosas.
Informações de Segurança
•
•
•
•
Se o produto NÃO estiver marcado com este símbolo,
conectado a uma tomada elétrica com ligação à terra.
, ele DEVE SER
O cabo de alimentação deve ser conectado a uma tomada elétrica localizada
perto do produto e de fácil acesso.
Para todos os serviços ou reparações não descritos nas instruções de operação,
entre em contato com um técnico dos serviços de assistência.
Este produto está projetado, testado e aprovado para satisfazer os padrões glo-
bais de segurança para uso de componentes específicos da Lexmark. Os recur-
sos de segurança de alguns componentes podem não ser sempre óbvios. A
Lexmark não é responsável pelo uso de outros componentes de substituição.
•
•
O produto usa raios laser, tome
CUIDADO: O uso de controles, ajustes ou a execução de procedimentos
diferentes dos especificados podem resultar em exposição perigosa a radi-
ações.
O produto usa um processo de impressão que aquece o meio de impressão.
Devido ao aquecimento, o meio pode liberar emissões. É necessário que você
entenda as instruções de operação sobre a escolha do meio de impressão, para
evitar emissões perigosas.
Appendix C: Safety Information
259
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Appendix C: Safety Information
260
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Appendix C: Safety Information
261
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Appendix C: Safety Information
262
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Appendix C: Safety Information
263
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Appendix C: Safety Information
264
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Warranty
D
Statement of Limited
Warranty
Lexmark International, Inc., Lexington, KY
This warranty applies to the United States and Canada. For customers outside the U.S.
and Canada, refer to the country-specific warranty information that came with your
printer.
Lexmark Optra M410 and
M412 Laser Printers
This Statement of Limited Warranty applies to this product if it was originally pur-
chased for your use, and not for resale, from Lexmark or a Lexmark remarketer, referred
to in this statement as “Remarketer.”
Warranty
Lexmark warrants that this product:
•
Is manufactured from new parts, or new and serviceable used parts, which per-
form like new parts,
•
•
•
Is free from defects in material and workmanship,
Conforms to Lexmark’s official published specifications, and
Is in good working order.
If this product does not function as warranted during the warranty period, contact a
Remarketer or Lexmark for repair without charge.
If this product is a feature or option, this statement applies only when that feature or
option is used with the product for which it was designed. To obtain warranty service,
you may be required to present the feature or option with the product.
If you transfer this product to another user, warranty service under the terms of this
statement is available to that user for the remainder of the warranty period. You should
transfer proof of original purchase and this statement to that user.
Appendix D: Warranty
265
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Warranty Service
The warranty period is 12 months and starts on the date of original purchase as shown
on the purchase receipt.
To obtain warranty service you may be required to present proof of original purchase.
Warranty service will be provided at your location.at a Remarketer or a Lexmark desig-
nated location. You may be required to deliver your product to the Remarketer or Lex-
mark, or ship it prepaid and suitably packaged to a Lexmark designated location. You
are responsible for loss of, or damage to, a product in transit to the Remarketer or the
designated location.at a Lexmark designated location.
•
•
at your location.
at a Remarketer or a Lexmark designated location. You may be required to
deliver your product to the Remarketer or Lexmark, or ship it prepaid and suit-
ably packaged to a Lexmark designated location. You are responsible for loss of,
or damage to, a product in transit to the Remarketer or the designated location.
•
at a Lexmark designated location.
When warranty service involves the exchange of a product or part, the item replaced
becomes the property of the Remarketer or Lexmark. The replacement may be a new or
repaired item. The replacement item assumes the remaining warranty period of the
original product.
Replacement is not available to you if the product you present for exchange is defaced,
altered, in need of a repair not included in warranty service, or damaged beyond repair.
Also, such product must be free of any legal obligation or restrictions that prevent its
exchange.
Before you present this product for warranty service, remove all programs, data, and
removable storage media.
For further explanation of your warranty alternatives and the nearest Lexmark autho-
rized servicer in your area, please contact Lexmark at 1-800-LEXMARK (1-800-539-
6275), or on the World Wide Web at http:/ / www.lexmark.com.
Free remote technical support is provided for this product throughout its warranty
period. Lexmark offers a variety of extended warranty programs that include an exten-
sion of technical support. For products no longer covered by a Lexmark warranty, tech-
nical support may only be available for a fee.
Extent of Warranty
We do not warrant uninterrupted or error-free operation of a product.
Warranty service does not include repair of failures caused by:
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
modification or attachments
accidents or misuse
unsuitable physical or operating environment
maintenance by anyone other than Lexmark or a Lexmark authorized servicer
operation of a product beyond the limit of its duty cycle
failure to have installed a maintenance kit as specified (if applicable)
use of printing media outside of Lexmark specifications
use of other than Lexmark supplies (such as toner cartridges, inkjet cartridges,
and ribbons)
•
use of other than Lexmark product or component
ALL EXPRESS AND IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING THE IMPLIED WAR-
RANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PUR-
POSE, ARE LIMITED IN DURATION TO THE WARRANTY PERIOD. NO
WARRANTIES, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, WILL APPLY AFTER THIS PERIOD.
Appendix D: Warranty
266
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Limitation of Liability
Your sole remedy under this Statement of Limited Warranty is set forth in this section.
For any claim concerning performance or nonperformance of Lexmark or a Remarketer
for this product under this Statement of Limited Warranty, you may recover actual
damages up to the limit set forth in the following paragraph.
Lexmark's liability for actual damages from any cause whatsoever will be limited to the
greater of 1) $5,000 or 2) the amount you paid for the product that caused the damages.
This limitation of liability will not apply to claims by you for bodily injury or damage to
real property or tangible personal property for which Lexmark is legally liable. In no
event will Lexmark be liable for any lost profits, lost savings, incidental damage, or
other economic consequential damages. This is true even if you advise Lexmark or a
Remarketer of the possibility of such damages. Lexmark is not liable for any claim by
you based on a third party claim.
This limitation of remedies also applies to any developer of materials supplied to Lex-
mark. Lexmark’s and the developer’s limitations of remedies are not cumulative. Such
developer is an intended beneficiary of this limitation.
Additional Rights
Some states do not allow limitations on how long an implied warranty lasts, or do not
allow the exclusion or limitation of incidental or consequential damages. If such laws
apply, the limitations or exclusions contained in this statement may not apply to you.
This warranty gives you specific legal rights. You may also have other rights which vary
from state to state.
Appendix D: Warranty
267
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Appendix D: Warranty
268
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Glossary
Numerics 7 3/4 Envelope. See Monarch.
9 Envelope. An envelope measuring 98.4 x 225.4 mm
(3.875 x 8.875 in.).
10 Envelope. See Com-10.
500-sheet optional drawer. An optional input tray and
drawer you can purchase for the printer to increase input
capacity.
1200 Image Quality. A print resolution setting that lets
the printer to vary the size of each printed pixel, thereby
producing a continuous tone effect. This setting improves
the print quality of graphic fills, images, and halftones.
A
A4. Print material measuring 210 x 297 mm
(8.27 x 11.7 in.).
A5. Print material measuring 148 x 210 mm
(5.83 x 8.27 in.).
all points addressable (APA). In computer graphics, the
ability to address and display, or not display, each picture
element (pel) on a display surface.
APA. See all points addressable.
application. See software application.
Glossary
269
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
attendance message. An operator panel message that
describes a printer problem. Operator intervention is
required before the printer can continue processing.
automated fax system. A Lexmark system for providing
customers with quick product information, technical tips,
and printer driver information.
automatic interface. A printer function that determines
the active interface: parallel, serial, network, infrared,
LocalTalk, or USB.
B
B5. (1) Envelope measuring 176 x 250 mm (6.93 x 9.84 in.).
(2) Print material measuring 182 x 257 mm
(7.17 x 10.12 in.).
baud. The rate, in bits per second (bps), at which data is
transferred to or from the computer through the serial
interface.
bidirectional communication. Two-way communication
between the printer and a computer, using Network
Printing Alliance Protocol (NPAP 1.0 standard).
bin. See output bin.
bitmapped font. Predefined pattern of bits that represent
a typeface at a specific size, style, and resolution.
bits per second (bps). A measurement of the speed of
data transferred through a serial interface.
bps. See bits per second.
buffer. A portion of memory used to temporarily store
data.
Glossary
270
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Busy. A printer state in which the printer is processing
data or printing pages.
byte. A group of eight binary digits processed as a unit.
Typically used to represent an alphanumeric character.
C
C5. Envelope measuring 162 x 229 mm (6.38 x 9.01 in.).
card stock. Heavy, single-ply print material frequently
used for reports or book covers.
Centronics parallel interface. A standard for connecting
printers and other peripheral devices to a computer. It
defines the plug, socket and electrical signals that are used
for controlling the transmission of data.
characters per inch (cpi). The number of characters that
can be printed in one inch.
Com-10. Also called a 10 Envelope. An envelope
measuring 104.8 x 241.3 mm (4.125 x 9.5 in.).
configuration. (1) The arrangement of a computer system,
printer, or network. (2) The devices and programs that
make up a system, subsystem, or network.
corona wire. A thin wire in the printer that electrically
charges the print material to attract toner from the
photoconductor.
curl. Curvature at the edge of a sheet of print material.
D
Data Set Ready (DSR). A “handshaking” signal
contained in a serial interface indicating the device is
ready to exchange information.
data stream. Print data and printer control information
that flows from the host system (computer) to the printer
without interruption.
Glossary
271
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Data Terminal Ready (DTR). A “handshaking” signal
contained in a serial interface indicating the device is
ready to exchange information.
default. An attribute, value, or setting that is assumed
when none is explicitly specified.
disk. See hard disk option.
display. See operator panel display.
DL. Envelope measuring 110 x 220 mm (4.33 x 8.66 in.).
download. To transfer information, such as fonts, from a
diskette or other device to your computer or printer for
temporary or permanent storage.
dpi. Dots per inch. See resolution.
DRAM. See dynamic random access memory.
driver. See printer driver.
DSR. See Data Set Ready.
DTR. See Data Terminal Ready.
duplex. To print on both sides of a sheet of print material.
dynamic random access memory (DRAM). Memory that
allows rapid storage and retrieval of data. DRAM contents
are erased when electrical power is turned off.
E
emulation. Imitation of a printer processing language. For
example, PCL 6 emulation imitates the Hewlett-Packard
LaserJet printer language.
ENA. External network adapter. See external print server.
error message. See attendance message.
Glossary
272
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Ethernet. A network with a bus topology that utilizes
carrier sense multiple access with collision detection
(CSMA/ CD). An Ethernet network may be installed using
any of three cabling systems:
•
•
Ethernet 10Base2 (using RG-58 coax)
Ethernet 10BaseT (using telephone twisted pair
cable)
•
Ethernet 100BaseTX
executive. Print material measuring 184.2 x 266.7 mm
(7.25 x 10.5 in.).
external network adapter (ENA). See external print server.
external print server. Also called an external network
adapter (ENA). A LAN device that attaches externally to
the printer and lets you connect various printers to your
network, thereby freeing dedicated PC print servers for
use as LAN workstations.
F
factory default. Printer setting defined when the printer is
manufactured.
Fastbytes protocol. A parallel printer protocol that
enables the printer to receive information at faster than
normal transmission rates.
fixed-pitch font. A font that prints each character in a
fixed amount of horizontal space, regardless of the width
of the character. These fonts are identified by the number
of characters that print in 1 inch of horizontal line space,
such as 10 pitch or 12 pitch.
flash memory. Optional memory you can install in the
printer to provide non-volatile storage for downloaded
fonts, symbol sets, or macros.
Glossary
273
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
font. A family or set of characters that have common
visual characteristics, such as size, weight, and style; for
example, Arial Bold.
fuser. The part of the printer that uses heat and pressure
to make toner adhere to the print material.
G
H
grain. The alignment of the paper fibers in a sheet of print
material. For example, in grain long paper, the fibers run
the length of the page.
g/m². Grams per square meter. Metric measurement for
print material weight.
handshaking. The exchange of predetermined signals
when a connection is established.
hard disk option. An optional device you can install in
the printer to provide non-volatile storage for
downloaded fonts, symbol sets, or macros.
hex trace. A diagnostic printer mode that lets you print
the uninterpreted printer data stream so you can see a
hexadecimal and character representation of a print job.
Honor INIT. A printer setting that allows the printer to be
reset by an initialization signal sent from the computer.
I
images. Visual data typically scanned from original
sources external to the PC, such as photographs or video
frames.
INA. Internal network adapter. See internal print server.
infrared adapter. An external device that uses a low-
power infrared beam to allow a computer to exchange
data with a printer without a physical connection between
the two.
Glossary
274
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
input source. A printer tray or the multipurpose feeder.
An input source holds print material for printing.
Integrated Network Option. See print server.
interface. The connection between the computer and the
printer.
internal network adapter (INA). See internal print server.
internal print server. Also called an internal network
adapter (INA). An optional card you can install in the
printer to connect it to a local area network (LAN).
J
job accounting. A printer feature that lets you store
statistical information about most recent printer jobs on a
hard disk option installed in the printer.
job buffering. A printer feature that lets you spool print
jobs to a hard disk option installed in the printer.
K
L
KB. Kilobyte; 1024 bytes.
LAN. See local area network.
landscape orientation. Printed page orientation in which
the width of the page is greater than the height.
LCD. See liquid crystal display.
leading edge. The edge of the printed page that exits the
printer first.
legal. Print material measuring 215.9 x 356 mm
(8.5 x 14 in.).
letter. Print material measuring 215.9 x 279.4 mm
(8.5 x 11 in.).
Glossary
275
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
lines per page (lpp). The number of lines of text that can
be printed on one page.
link. The connection between the computer system or
local area network and the printer.
liquid crystal display (LCD). The display technology that
shows operator panel messages and menu selections.
local area network (LAN). A computer network located
on a user’s premises within a limited geographical area.
long-edge binding. A printer setting that arranges the
orientation and layout of a duplexed page to be bound
along the long side of the page.
LPTx. A representation of one of the logical parallel ports
(for example, LPT1) on a personal computer.
M
macro. A collection of commands grouped together and
temporarily or permanently stored in printer memory.
manual feed. A process of feeding print material (paper,
envelope, label, transparency, card stock) into the
multipurpose feeder on the printer one sheet at a time.
MarkNet S. Family of multi-protocol Lexmark internal
print servers. Ethernet and Token-Ring versions are
available.
MarkNet XLe. Family of multi-protocol Lexmark external
print servers. Ethernet, Token-Ring, and LocalTalk
versions are available.
MarkVision. A printer utility that provides continuous
printer status and lets you configure multiple printers
from a single setup file.
MB. Megabyte; 1,048,576 bytes.
media. See print material.
Glossary
276
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
menu. A list of choices that control printer operation,
printer features, and the appearance of the printed page.
menu item. See setting.
Monarch. Also called a 7 3/ 4 Envelope. An envelope
measuring 98.4 x 190.5 mm (3.875 x 7.5 in.).
monospaced font. A font in which the space for each
character does not vary, regardless of the width of the
character.
multipurpose feeder. A print material input source on the
front of the printer that lets you load a small stack of
paper, envelopes, transparencies, labels, and odd-size
print material. You can also use the multipurpose feeder
to manually feed print material into the printer one sheet
at a time.
N
network. A group of computers, printers, and other
hardware devices connected to each other to share
information.
network adapter. See print server.
non-volatile random access memory (NVRAM).
Memory that allows rapid storing and retrieving of data.
NVRAM contents are preserved when electrical power is
turned off.
Not Ready. A printer state in which the printer does not
accept data from the computer. This state is initiated
either by operator intervention or a printer error.
O
operating system. The basic software which provides the
low-level functions needed to operate your computer,
such as booting up.
Operation ReSource. A Lexmark process established to
recycle toner cartridges and print units.
Glossary
277
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
operator panel. The buttons and liquid crystal display
(LCD) on the printer that are used to change printer
settings and display printer status.
operator panel display. The liquid crystal display on the
operator panel that shows printer menus and messages.
operator panel overlay. An adhesive label with translated
names for the operator panel display buttons and
numbers in one language. A package of overlays is
supplied for you to select the label with the language you
need.
orientation. A page description defining whether the
printed text runs along the short edge (portrait) or the
long edge (landscape) of the page.
Other Envelope. Value to select for all envelopes that are
not a standard size; defaults to 229.11 x 356 mm
(9.02 x 14 in.). Set the actual size of the envelope from your
software application.
output bin. A print material exit area. The default is the
standard output bin, located on top of the printer. A rear
output bin, located on the back of the printer, is also
available.
overlay. Background text or graphics that appear
consistent in each file that uses the overlay.
P
pages per minute (ppm). The number of typical pages of
text that can be printed in one minute.
paper. See print material.
paper guides. The length guide and the width guide
located in an input tray that define proper placement of
print material. Failing to properly adjust these guides may
result in paper jams.
Glossary
278
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
paper type. A printer setting that defines the type of print
material (plain paper, card stock, transparency, label,
bond, letterhead, preprinted, colored paper, envelope, or
custom) loaded in a specified input source.
parallel interface. A bidirectional interface for exchanging
data between the computer and the printer.
parallel/USB interface option card. An optional card that
connects your printer to a parallel interface and a
Universal Serial Bus (USB).
pel. Picture element. The smallest addressable unit that
can be effectively reproduced by the printer.
photoconductor. An element of the print unit that works
like film in a camera. As the photoconductor drum rotates,
it uses positive and negative charges to alternately attract
the toner necessary to define the image produced by the
laser and transfer the image to the page. Fingerprints or
scratches on the photoconductor prevent proper toner
transfer and may result in reduced print quality.
pitch. A unit of measure that determines the number of
characters that can be printed in 1 horizontal inch. For
example, a 10-pitch font prints 10 characters per inch (cpi).
point. A unit of measure that determines the height of a
printed character (1 point = 1/ 72 in.).
point size. The height of the characters in a font.
portrait orientation. Printed page orientation in which the
height of the page is greater than the width.
power saver. A printer setting that reduces power usage
when the printer is idle. When the Power Saver message
displays, the printer is ready to receive print jobs.
ppm. See pages per minute.
PQET. See Print Quality Enhancement Technology.
Glossary
279
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
precharger wire. A wire inside the print unit that
electrically charges the photoconductor during the
printing process.
Print and Hold job. A print job sent from your software
application, stored in printer memory, and accessed at a
later time from the CONFIDENTIAL JOB menu item or the
HELD JOBS menu item. A Print and Hold job lets you
delay the printing of a job, print it later, ask for additional
copies, verify one copy before printing more, and access
confidential print jobs by using a Personal Identification
Number (PIN).
print cartridge. The replaceable unit inside the printer
that contains the photoconductor and toner supply.
print material. Any material you print on, such as paper,
card stock, envelopes, labels, and transparencies.
Print Quality Enhancement Technology (PQET).
A printer feature that improves the quality of text by
smoothing the edges of characters and lines.
print server. A device that lets you connect the printer to a
local area network (LAN).
printer driver. A program that translates software
application language to printer language so data can be
transferred.
printer language. A set of defined commands (such as
PCL or PostScript) to which the printer responds.
printer memory. See dynamic random access memory
(DRAM) or random access memory (RAM).
proportionally spaced font. A font that varies the width
of the character to allow uniform spacing around
characters.
protocol. A set of rules governing the communication and
data transfer between two or more devices.
Glossary
280
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
R
RAM. See random access memory.
random access memory (RAM). Memory that allows
rapid storage and retrieval of data. RAM contents are
erased when electrical power is turned off.
Ready. A printer state in which the printer can receive,
process, and print data.
resolution. A measure of the sharpness of a printed
image, expressed in the number of dots per inch (dpi).
S
scalable font. A font whose characters are stored only as
outlines so it is easy to change (or scale) the size of the
characters (measured in points).
screen font. A downloadable font that appears the same
on the computer screen as it does on a printed page.
serial interface. A way of communicating between
computer and printer by transmitting data one bit at a
time.
server. A device that allows the sharing of resources, such
as printers, on a network.
service message. An operator panel display message that
indicates the printer needs service.
setting. Values you choose from printer menus or
software applications that control printer operation and
the appearance of the printed page.
setup utility. A program provided with the printer that
installs printer drivers, tests printer setup, and completes
the setup of printer options.
short-edge binding. A printer setting that arranges the
orientation and layout of a duplexed page to be bound
along the short side of the page.
simplex. See single-sided printing.
Glossary
281
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
single-sided printing. Printing on only one side of a sheet
of print material (simplex printing).
SmartSwitch. A printer function that automatically
switches the printer language to match that of the current
print job.
software application. Any program loaded on your
computer used to perform a specific task, such as word
processing or data compiling.
Standard protocol. A parallel printer protocol where the
printer receives information sent from the computer at a
normal transmission rate.
status message. A operator panel display message that
provides information on the state of the printer.
symbol set. A unique set of alphanumeric characters and
symbols that the printer uses to print the requested font.
Different symbol sets offer the diverse characters required
for different languages or symbol-intense applications.
system board. The printer main circuit board.
T
timeout. A time interval allotted for certain operations.
Token-Ring. A type of network communication that
conforms to IEEE 802.5 standard. The name is derived
from its physical ring configuration and the passing of a
token from print server to print server.
toner. The material that adheres to the print material to
create a printed page.
toner cartridge. See print cartridge.
tray linking. A means of increasing input source capacity
by feeding print material from one input source until it is
empty and then automatically feeding print material from
another input source.
Glossary
282
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Tri-Port interface option card. An optional card you can
install inside the printer to add support for LocalTalk,
serial, and infrared interfaces.
TrueType fonts. Fonts that use a single font outline for
both screen display and printing. You can use TrueType
fonts in Windows applications and scale them to any
height. They print exactly as they appear on the screen.
type size. A measurement in pitch or points of a graphic
character in a font.
type style. The form or shape of the characters in a font.
typeface. The style that defines a group of characters and
symbols.
typographic fonts. Fonts whose characters are spaced
proportionally on the page according to character width.
U
Universal. Value to select for all print material excluding
envelopes loaded in the multipurpose feeder that is not a
standard size; defaults to 215.9 x 356 mm (8.5 x 14 in.). Set
the actual size of the page from your software application.
Universal Serial Bus (USB). An industry accepted serial
bus for external devices. It replaces all the different types
of serial and parallel ports with one standardized plug.
USB. See Universal Serial Bus.
user default. Printer setting selected by a user that
remains in effect until a new user default is chosen.
V
value. One of the settings available for a menu item.
Glossary
283
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
W
watermark. See overlay.
weight. The thickness of the typeface line or the thickness
of print material.
Glossary
284
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
attendance messages (continued)
CD
changing printer settings
characters
closing
confidential jobs
B
Config Menu
configuring
C
cable
USB, attaching
Index
286
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
factory default settings (continued)
Factory Defaults
D
fax
default settings
dimensions
disabling
disk
See hard disk option
display problems
Fax Menu
Finishing Menu
E
flash memory option
envelopes
F
factory default settings
Index
287
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
flash memory option (continued)
H
fonts
hard disk option
I
indicators
G
guidelines
information, online documents
infrared
Infrared Menu
Index
288
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Infrared Menu (continued)
Job Buffering
job buffering
input tray
See tray
installing
Job Menu
job statistics
internal network adapter
L
LCD
See liquid crystal display
length guide, adjusting
letterhead
J
jagged
jams, paper
See paper jams
Index
289
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
loading
media guidelines (continued)
memory
menus
LocalTalk Menu
M
Macintosh
selecting
settings
MarkVision
media guidelines
messages
Index
290
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
messages (continued)
NPA Mode
multipurpose feeder
loading
O
opening
operator panel
N
network adapter
menu settings
messages
Network Menu
problems
network printing problems
Index
291
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
option card
option problems
paper (continued)
options
paper guide
paper jams
ordering supplies
OS/ 2 Warp
Paper Menu
output bin
P
paper
paper size indicators
jams
selecting
Index
292
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
paper sources (continued)
PCL emulation
parallel cable
PCL SmartSwitch
Parallel Menu
PIN
See personal identification number
PostScript 3 emulation
parallel/ USB interface option card
PostScript Menu
part number
print
PCL Emul Menu
HELD JOBS (Job Menu)
Index
293
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
print cartridge
print quality problems
jagged
print material
guidelines
printer
attendance messages
selecting
sizes supported
service messages
See service messages
Index
294
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
printer (continued)
status messages
printing (continued)
See status messages
warning messages
See warning messages
printer messages
attendance
service
printing problems
See service messages
status
See problem solving
problem solving
See status messages
warning messages
See warning messages
printer settings
printer setup
display
printer states
lost data
printing
network printing problems
contents
Index
295
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
problem solving (continued)
operator panel
problem solving (continued)
printing problems (continued)
options
paper jams
PS SmartSwitch
print quality
jagged
Q
Quality Menu
printer
R
printing problems
Index
296
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
removing
Serial Menu
resetting
settings
resolution
Setup Menu
S
side cover
scalable fonts
selecting
Index
297
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
tray
Utilities Menu
V
U
unpacking
USB cable
W
attaching
USB Menu
user default settings
width guide, adjusting
Windows
utilities
Index
299
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Index
300
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
|
Land Pride Lawn Mower 701 069A User Manual
Lennox International Inc Gas Heater Lennox Merit Series Gas Furnace Upflow Horizontal Air Discharge User Manual
Life Fitness Elliptical Trainer X30 User Manual
Life Fitness Fitness Equipment M051 00K59 0014 User Manual
Marantz CD Player CDR300 User Manual
Marvel Group Computer Hardware 88F6281 User Manual
M Audio Microphone 81602 User Manual
Maytag Washer W10373814A User Manual
Melissa Fondue Maker 643 052 User Manual
Metra Electronics Radio 95 7321 User Manual